LMK04806BISQE/NOPB [TI]

具有双级联 PLL 和集成式 2.5GHz VCO 的低噪声时钟抖动消除器 | NKD | 64 | -40 to 85;
LMK04806BISQE/NOPB
型号: LMK04806BISQE/NOPB
厂家: TEXAS INSTRUMENTS    TEXAS INSTRUMENTS
描述:

具有双级联 PLL 和集成式 2.5GHz VCO 的低噪声时钟抖动消除器 | NKD | 64 | -40 to 85

时钟 外围集成电路 晶体
文件: 总140页 (文件大小:2185K)
中文:  中文翻译
下载:  下载PDF数据表文档文件
Sample &  
Buy  
Support &  
Community  
Product  
Folder  
Tools &  
Software  
Technical  
Documents  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
LMK0480x Low-Noise Clock Jitter Cleaner with Dual Loop PLLs  
1 Features  
3 Description  
The LMK0480x family is the industry's highest  
performance clock conditioner with superior clock  
jitter cleaning, generation, and distribution with  
advanced features to meet next generation system  
1
Ultra-Low RMS Jitter Performance  
111 fs RMS Jitter (12 kHz to 20 MHz)  
123 fs RMS Jitter (100 Hz to 20 MHz)  
requirements.  
The  
dual  
loop  
PLLatinum™  
Dual Loop PLLatinum™ PLL Architecture  
PLL1  
architecture is capable of 111 fs rms jitter (12 kHz to  
20 MHz) using a low noise VCXO module or sub-200  
fs rms jitter (12 kHz to 20 MHz) using a low cost  
external crystal and varactor diode.  
Integrated Low-Noise Crystal Oscillator Circuit  
Holdover Mode when Input Clocks are Lost  
Automatic or Manual Triggering/Recovery  
The dual loop architecture consists of two high-  
performance phase-locked loops (PLL), a low-noise  
crystal oscillator circuit, and a high-performance  
voltage controlled oscillator (VCO). The first PLL  
(PLL1) provides low-noise jitter cleaner functionality  
while the second PLL (PLL2) performs the clock  
generation. PLL1 can be configured to either work  
with an external VCXO module or the integrated  
crystal oscillator with an external tunable crystal and  
varactor diode. When paired with a very narrow loop  
bandwidth, PLL1 uses the superior close-in phase  
noise (offsets below 50 kHz) of the VCXO module or  
the tunable crystal to clean the input clock. The  
output of PLL1 is used as the clean input reference to  
PLL2 where it locks the integrated VCO. The loop  
bandwidth of PLL2 can be optimized to clean the far-  
out phase noise (offsets above 50 kHz) where the  
integrated VCO outperforms the VCXO module or  
tunable crystal used in PLL1.  
PLL2  
Normalized PLL Noise Floor of –227 dBc/Hz  
Phase Detector Rate up to 155 MHz  
OSCin Frequency-Doubler  
Integrated Low-Noise VCO  
2 Redundant Input Clocks with LOS  
Automatic and Manual Switch-Over Modes  
50 % Duty Cycle Output Divides, 1 to 1045 (Even  
and Odd)  
12 LVPECL, LVDS, or LVCMOS Programmable  
Outputs  
Digital Delay: Fixed or Dynamically Adjustable  
25 ps Step Analog Delay Control.  
14 Differential Outputs. Up to 26 Single Ended.  
Up to 6 VCXO/Crystal Buffered Outputs  
Device Information  
Clock Rates of up to 1536 MHz  
0-Delay Mode  
REFERENCE  
INPUTS  
PART NUMBER  
VCO FREQUENCY  
Three Default Clock Outputs at Power Up  
LMK04803  
LMK04805  
LMK04806  
LMK04808  
1840 to 2030 MHz  
2148 to 2370 MHz  
2370 to 2600 MHz  
2750 to 3072 MHz  
Multi-Mode: Dual PLL, Single PLL, and Clock  
Distribution  
2
Industrial Temperature Range: –40 to 85°C  
3.15-V to 3.45-V Operation  
(1) For all available packages, see the orderable addendum at  
the end of the datasheet.  
2 Dedicated Buffered/Divided OSCin Clocks  
Package: 64-Pin WQFN (9.0 × 9.0 × 0.8 mm)  
Simplified Schematic  
OSCout0/  
OSCout1  
0XOWLSOHꢀ³FOHDQ´ꢀ  
clocks at different  
frequencies  
2
Applications  
Crystal or  
VCXO  
LMX2541  
PLL+VCO  
Recovered  
³GLUW\´ꢀFORFNꢀRUꢀ  
clean clock  
Data Converter Clocking  
CLKin0  
CLKout0, 1  
Backup  
Reference  
Clock  
Wireless Infrastructure  
CLKout2  
CLKout3  
LMK0480x  
FPGA  
Serializer/  
Deserializer  
CLKin1  
I
Precision Clock  
Conditioner  
Networking, SONET/SDH, DSLAM  
Medical / Video / Military / Aerospace  
Test and Measurement  
CLKout4, 5, 6, 7  
CLKout8A  
CLKout11  
CLKout9  
IF  
DAC  
ADC  
CPLD  
Q
1
An IMPORTANT NOTICE at the end of this data sheet addresses availability, warranty, changes, use in safety-critical applications,  
intellectual property matters and other important disclaimers. PRODUCTION DATA.  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Table of Contents  
8.5 Programming........................................................... 47  
8.6 Register Maps......................................................... 51  
Application and Implementation ........................ 97  
9.1 Application Information............................................ 97  
9.2 Typical Applications .............................................. 114  
9.3 System Examples ................................................. 122  
9.4 Do's and Don'ts..................................................... 124  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Features.................................................................. 1  
Applications ........................................................... 1  
Description ............................................................. 1  
Revision History..................................................... 2  
Pin Configuration and Functions......................... 4  
Specifications......................................................... 6  
6.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ...................................... 6  
6.2 ESD Ratings.............................................................. 6  
6.3 Recommended Operating Conditions....................... 6  
6.4 Thermal Information.................................................. 7  
6.5 Electrical Characteristics........................................... 7  
6.6 Timing Requirements.............................................. 13  
9
10 Power Supply Recommendations ................... 125  
10.1 Pin Connection Recommendations..................... 125  
10.2 Current Consumption and Power Dissipation  
Calculations............................................................ 126  
11 Layout................................................................. 129  
11.1 Layout Guidelines ............................................... 129  
11.2 Layout Example .................................................. 130  
12 Device and Documentation Support ............... 131  
12.1 Device Support.................................................... 131  
12.2 Documentation Support ...................................... 131  
12.3 Related Links ...................................................... 131  
12.4 Trademarks......................................................... 131  
12.5 Electrostatic Discharge Caution.......................... 131  
12.6 Glossary.............................................................. 131  
6.7 Typical Characteristics: Clock Output AC  
Characteristics ......................................................... 14  
7
8
Parameter Measurement Information ................ 15  
7.1 Charge Pump Current Specification Definitions...... 15  
7.2 Differential Voltage Measurement Terminology...... 16  
Detailed Description ............................................ 17  
8.1 Overview ................................................................. 17  
8.2 Functional Block Diagram ....................................... 21  
8.3 Feature Description................................................. 22  
8.4 Device Functional Modes........................................ 43  
13 Mechanical, Packaging, and Orderable  
Information ......................................................... 131  
4 Revision History  
Changes from Revision J (March 2013) to Revision K  
Page  
Changed 90 to 80 and 80 to 90 for fCLKout-startup parameter in Electrical Characteristics....................................................... 11  
Added "Specification is not valid for CLKoutX or CLKoutY in analog delay mode" in table note for Electrical  
Characteristics ..................................................................................................................................................................... 11  
Changed "Temperature" to "Ambient Temperature" in heading titled "Charge Pump Output Current Magnitude  
Variation vs. Ambient Temperature" .................................................................................................................................... 15  
Added "temporarily" in VCXO/CRYSTAL Buffered Outputs ................................................................................................ 18  
Changed from "n possible" to "D possible" in 0-Delay ......................................................................................................... 20  
Changed "can" to "cannot" in Input Clock Switching - Pin Select Mode .............................................................................. 24  
Deleted Clock Switch Event without Holdover in Clock Switch Event with Holdover .......................................................... 25  
Added paragraph beginning "For applications ..." in PLL2 Frequency Doubler................................................................... 29  
Changed 5 to15 in Table 11................................................................................................................................................. 42  
Deleted Mode 5 row in Table 12 .......................................................................................................................................... 43  
Added Mode 15 Additional Configurations section .............................................................................................................. 46  
In Table 16, added [27:26], [23:22], and [21:20] for Register 27 row. Added [31:20] for R28. Added [26:24] for R30.  
Added [7:6]. .......................................................................................................................................................................... 51  
In Table 18, changed "Actual PLL2 N divider value used in calibration routine". Added footnote "Inversion for Status  
0 and 1 pins is only valid for CLKin_SELECT_MODE = 0x06"............................................................................................ 56  
In Table 28, added "to reduce supply..." footnote for 9 through 14. Added footnote "To reduce supply switching and  
crosstalk noise, it is recommended to use a complementary LVCMOS output type such as 6 or 7". ................................. 64  
Added footnote "To reduce supply" for 8 through 14 in Table 32 ....................................................................................... 66  
Changed "Divide" to "Definition" in Table 39, Table 40, Table 61, and Table 62 ................................................................ 68  
Changed to "MUX OUTPUT" in Table header row in Table 42............................................................................................ 69  
In Table 43, added footnote, "Contact TI Applications for more information on using this mode". Changed to "Dual  
2
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Revision History (continued)  
PLL, External VCO (Fin), 0-Delay" for 15 (0x0F) ................................................................................................................. 70  
Added "Inversion for Status 0 and 1 pins is only valid for CLKin_SELECT_MODE = 0x06" in CLKin_Sel_INV................. 78  
In FORCE_HOLDOVER, added "(EN_TRACK = 0 or 1, EN_MAN_DAC =1)". Added "(EN_TRACK = 1,  
EN_MAN_DAC = 0, EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DET = 0)".............................................................................................................. 82  
Changed to R[23:14] in DAC_CNT....................................................................................................................................... 83  
In Table 90, added (0x0000), (0x0001), (0x0002), (0x0003). Changed "Divide" to "Value" in the header row. .................. 87  
Added (0x00) through (0x04) in Table 91............................................................................................................................. 88  
Added PLL2 Frequency Doubler .......................................................................................................................................... 88  
Changed from "Divide" to "Value" in Table 95 ..................................................................................................................... 89  
Added PLL2 Frequency Doubler reference in Table 103..................................................................................................... 92  
Added note "Unless in 0-delay..." in PLL2_N_CAL, PLL2 N Calibration Divider ................................................................ 93  
Changed "Mode_MUX1" to "VCO_MUX" in PLL2_P, PLL2 N Prescaler Divider................................................................. 94  
Changed "register" to "Defintion" in table header row for Table 110 ................................................................................... 95  
Updated Minimum Digital Lock Detect Time Calculation Example ................................................................................... 107  
Added "Performance of other LMK0480x devices will be similar" in Optional Crystal Oscillator Implementation  
(OSCin/OSCin*).................................................................................................................................................................. 110  
Changed to "(fs rms)" in Table 125 ................................................................................................................................... 111  
Added text in red for Figure 40 .......................................................................................................................................... 123  
In Vcc2, Vcc3, Vcc10, Vcc11, Vcc12, Vcc13 (CLKout Vccs), added bullet point starting with "It is recommended..."  
Changed 10 MHz to 30 MHz........................................................................................................................................ 125  
Added paragraph "It is recommended..." in Vcc5 (CLKin and OSCout1), Vcc7 (OSCin and OSCout0) ........................... 126  
Added Mode = 15. Removed Mode = 5 in Table 127 ........................................................................................................ 127  
Deleted "of about 2 square inches" in Layout Guidelines .................................................................................................. 129  
Changes from Revision I (March 2013) to Revision J  
Page  
Changed layout of National Data Sheet to TI format ............................................................................................................. 1  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
3
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
5 Pin Configuration and Functions  
64-Pin WQFN with Exposed Pad  
NKD Package  
(Top View)  
64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49  
CLKout0  
CLKout0*  
CLKout1*  
CLKout1  
NC  
CLKout6  
Vcc10  
1
2
48  
47  
46  
45  
44  
43  
42  
41  
40  
39  
38  
37  
36  
35  
34  
33  
DATAuWire  
CLKuWire  
LEuWire  
Vcc9  
3
4
5
SYNC  
6
NC  
CPout2  
Vcc8  
7
NC  
8
Top Down View  
NC  
OSCout0*  
OSCout0  
Vcc7  
9
Vcc1  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
LDObyp1  
LDObyp2  
CLKout2  
CLKout2*  
CLKout3*  
CLKout3  
OSCin*  
OSCin  
Vcc6  
CPout1  
Status_LD  
DAP  
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32  
Pin Functions(1)  
PIN  
I/O  
TYPE  
DESCRIPTION  
NUMBER  
NAME  
1, 2  
3, 4  
6
CLKout0, CLKout0*  
CLKout1*, CLKout1  
SYNC  
O
O
Programmable  
Programmable  
Programmable  
Clock output 0 (clock group 0).  
Clock output 1 (clock group 0).  
I/O  
CLKout Synchronization input or programmable status pin.  
No Connection. These pins must be left floating.  
Power supply for VCO LDO.  
5, 7, 8, 9  
10  
NC  
Vcc1  
PWR  
11  
LDObyp1  
ANLG  
LDO Bypass, bypassed to ground with 10 µF capacitor.  
LDO Bypass, bypassed to ground with a 0.1 µF capacitor.  
Clock output 2 (clock group 1).  
12  
LDObyp2  
ANLG  
13, 14  
15, 16  
17  
CLKout2, CLKout2*  
CLKout3*, CLKout3  
Vcc2  
O
O
Programmable  
Programmable  
PWR  
Clock output 3 (clock group 1).  
Power supply for clock group 1: CLKout2 and CLKout3.  
Power supply for clock group 2: CLKout4 and CLKout5.  
18  
Vcc3  
PWR  
(1) See Pin Connection Recommendations.  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
4
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Pin Functions(1) (continued)  
PIN  
I/O  
TYPE  
DESCRIPTION  
NUMBER  
NAME  
19, 20  
21, 22  
23  
CLKout4, CLKout4*  
CLKout5*, CLKout5  
GND  
O
O
Programmable  
Programmable  
PWR  
Clock output 4 (clock group 2).  
Clock output 5 (clock group 2).  
Ground.  
24  
Vcc4  
PWR  
Power supply for digital.  
CLKin1, CLKin1*  
Reference Clock Input Port 1 for PLL1. AC or DC Coupled.  
Feedback input for external clock feedback input (0-delay  
mode). AC or DC Coupled.  
FBCLKin, FBCLKin*  
Fin/Fin*  
25, 26  
I
ANLG  
External VCO input (External VCO mode). AC or DC  
Coupled.  
Programmable status pin, default readback output.  
Programmable to holdover mode indicator. Other options  
available by programming.  
27  
Status_Holdover  
CLKin0, CLKin0*  
I/O  
I
Programmable  
ANLG  
Reference Clock Input Port 0 for PLL1.  
AC or DC Coupled.  
28, 29  
30  
Vcc5  
PWR  
Power supply for clock inputs and OSCout1.  
Buffered output 1 of OSCin port.  
31, 32  
OSCout1, OSCout1*  
O
I/O  
O
LVPECL  
Programmable status pin, default lock detect for PLL1 and  
PLL2. Other options available by programming.  
33  
Status_LD  
Programmable  
34  
35  
CPout1  
Vcc6  
ANLG  
PWR  
Charge pump 1 output.  
Power supply for PLL1, charge pump 1.  
Feedback to PLL1, Reference input to PLL2.  
AC Coupled.  
36, 37  
OSCin, OSCin*  
I
ANLG  
38  
Vcc7  
PWR  
Power supply for OSCin, OSCout0, and PLL2 circuitry.(2)  
Buffered output 0 of OSCin port.(2)  
Power supply for PLL2, charge pump 2.  
Charge pump 2 output.  
39, 40  
41  
OSCout0, OSCout0*  
Vcc8  
O
O
Programmable  
PWR  
42  
CPout2  
ANLG  
43  
Vcc9  
PWR  
Power supply for PLL2.  
44  
LEuWire  
I
I
I
CMOS  
MICROWIRE Latch Enable Input.  
45  
CLKuWire  
CMOS  
MICROWIRE Clock Input.  
46  
DATAuWire  
Vcc10  
CMOS  
MICROWIRE Data Input.  
47  
PWR  
Power supply for clock group 3: CLKout6 and CLKout7.  
Clock output 6 (clock group 3).  
48, 49  
50, 51  
52  
CLKout6, CLKout6*  
CLKout7*, CLKout7  
Vcc11  
O
O
Programmable  
Programmable  
PWR  
Clock output 7 (clock group 3).  
Power supply for clock group 4: CLKout8 and CLKout9.  
Clock output 8 (clock group 4).  
53, 54  
55, 56  
57  
CLKout8, CLKout8*  
CLKout9*, CLKout9  
Vcc12  
O
O
Programmable  
Programmable  
PWR  
Clock output 9 (clock group 4).  
Power supply for clock group 5: CLKout10 and CLKout11.  
CLKout10,  
CLKout10*  
58, 59  
60, 61  
O
O
Programmable  
Programmable  
Clock output 10 (clock group 5).  
Clock output 11 (clock group 5).  
CLKout11*,  
CLKout11  
Programmable status pin. Default is input for pin control of  
PLL1 reference clock selection. CLKin0 LOS status and  
other options available by programming.  
62  
63  
Status_CLKin0  
Status_CLKin1  
I/O  
I/O  
Programmable  
Programmable  
Programmable status pin. Default is input for pin control of  
PLL1 reference clock selection. CLKin1 LOS status and  
other options available by programming.  
64  
Vcc13  
DAP  
PWR  
GND  
Power supply for clock group 0: CLKout0 and CLKout1.  
DIE ATTACH PAD, connect to GND.  
DAP  
(2) See Vcc5 (CLKin and OSCout1), Vcc7 (OSCin and OSCout0) for information on configuring device for optimum performance.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
5
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
6 Specifications  
6.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings(1)(2)(3)  
over operating free-air temperature range (unless otherwise noted)  
(4)  
MIN  
MAX  
UNIT  
(5)  
VCC  
VIN  
Supply Voltage  
Input Voltage  
–0.3  
3.6  
V
(VCC  
0.3)  
+
–0.3  
V
TL  
TJ  
Lead Temperature (solder 4 seconds)  
Junction Temperature  
+260  
150  
°C  
°C  
Differential Input Current (CLKinX/X*,  
OSCin/OSCin*, FBCLKin/FBCLKin*, Fin/Fin*)  
IIN  
± 5  
mA  
MSL  
Tstg  
Moisture Sensitivity Level  
Storage temperature range  
3
-65  
150  
°C  
(1) "Absolute Maximum Ratings" indicate limits beyond which damage to the device may occur. Operating Ratings indicate conditions for  
which the device is intended to be functional, but do not ensure specific performance limits. For ensured specifications and test  
conditions, see the Electrical Characteristics. The ensured specifications apply only to the test conditions listed.  
(2) Stresses in excess of the absolute maximum ratings can cause permanent or latent damage to the device. These are absolute stress  
ratings only. Functional operation of the device is only implied at these or any other conditions in excess of those given in the operation  
sections of the data sheet. Exposure to absolute maximum ratings for extended periods can adversely affect device reliability.  
(3) If Military/Aerospace specified devices are required, contact the Texas Instruments Sales Office/Distributors for availability and  
specifications.  
(4) Stresses beyond those listed under Absolute Maximum Ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings  
only, which do not imply functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under Recommended  
Operating Conditions. Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability.  
(5) Never to exceed 3.6 V.  
6.2 ESD Ratings  
VALUE  
±2000  
±150  
UNIT  
Human-body model (HBM), per ANSI/ESDA/JEDEC JS-001(1)  
Machine model (MM)  
V(ESD)  
Electrostatic discharge  
V
Charged-device model (CDM), per JEDEC specification JESD22-  
C101(2)  
±750  
(1) JEDEC document JEP155 states that 500-V HBM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process. Manufacturing with  
less than 500-V HBM is possible with the necessary precautions. Pins listed as ±2000 V may actually have higher performance.  
(2) JEDEC document JEP157 states that 250-V CDM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process. Manufacturing with  
less than 250-V CDM is possible with the necessary precautions. Pins listed as ±750 V may actually have higher performance.  
6.3 Recommended Operating Conditions  
MIN  
NOM  
MAX  
125  
85  
UNIT  
°C  
TJ  
Junction Temperature  
Ambient Temperature  
Supply Voltage  
TA  
VCC = 3.3 V  
-40  
25  
°C  
VCC  
3.15  
3.3  
3.45  
V
6
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
6.4 Thermal Information  
LMK0480x  
THERMAL METRIC(1)  
NKD  
64 PINS  
25.2  
6.9  
UNIT  
RθJA  
Junction-to-ambient thermal resistance on 4-layer JEDEC PCB(2)(3)  
Junction-to-case (top) thermal resistance(4)(5)  
Junction-to-board thermal resistance(6)  
Junction-to-top characterization parameter(7)  
Junction-to-board characterization parameter(8)  
Junction-to-case (bottom) thermal resistance(9)  
RθJC(top)  
RθJB  
4.0  
°C/W  
ψJT  
0.1  
ψJB  
4.0  
RθJC(bot)  
0.8  
(1) For more information about traditional and new thermal metrics, see the IC Package Thermal Metrics application report, SPRA953.  
(2) The junction-to-ambient thermal resistance under natural convection is obtained in a simulation on a JEDEC-standard, High-K board, as  
specified in JESD51-7, in an environment described in JESD51-2a.  
(3) Specification assumes 32 thermal vias connect the die attach pad to the embedded copper plane on the 4-layer JEDEC PCB. These  
vias play a key role in improving the thermal performance of the WQFN. Note that the JEDEC PCB is a standard thermal measurement  
PCB and does not represent best performance a PCB can achieve. It is recommended that the maximum number of vias be used in the  
board layout. R θJA is unique for each PCB.  
(4) The junction-to-case(top) thermal resistance is obtained by simulating a cold plate test on the package top. No specific JEDEC standard  
test exists, but a close description can be found in the ANSI SEMI standard G30-88.  
(5) Case is defined as the DAP (die attach pad)  
(6) The junction-to-board thermal resistance is obtained by simulating an environment with a ring cold plate fixture to control the PCB  
temperature, as described in JESD51-8.  
(7) The junction-to-top characterization parameter, ψJT, estimates the junction temperature of a device in a real system and is extracted  
from the simulation data for obtaining RθJA, using a procedure described in JESD51-2a (sections 6 and 7).  
(8) The junction-to-board characterization parameter, ψJB, estimates the junction temperature of a device in a real system and is extracted  
from the simulation data for obtaining RθJA, using a procedure described in JESD51-2a (sections 6 and 7).  
(9) The junction-to-case(bottom) thermal resistance is obtained by simulating a cold plate test on the exposed (power) pad. No specific  
JEDEC standard test exists, but a close description can be found in the ANSI SEMI standard G30-88.  
6.5 Electrical Characteristics  
3.15 V VCC 3.45 V, -40 °C TA 85°C. Typical values represent most likely parametric norms at VCC = 3.3 V, TA = 25°C,  
at the Recommended Operating Conditions at the time of product characterization and are not specified.(1)  
PARAMETER  
TEST CONDITIONS  
MIN  
TYP  
MAX UNIT  
CURRENT CONSUMPTION  
No DC path to ground on  
OSCout1/1*(2)  
ICC_PD  
Power down supply current  
1
3
mA  
mA  
All clock delays disabled,  
CLKoutX_Y_DIV = 1045,  
CLKoutX_TYPE = 1 (LVDS),  
PLL1 and PLL2 locked.  
ICC_CLKS  
Supply current with all clocks enabled(3)  
505  
590  
CLKin0/0* and CLKin1/1* INPUT CLOCK SPECIFICATIONS  
fCLKin  
Clock input frequency(4)  
Clock input slew rate(5)  
0.001  
0.15  
0.25  
0.5  
500  
MHz  
V/ns  
|V|  
(1)  
SLEWCLKin  
VIDCLKin  
VSSCLKin  
VIDCLKin  
VSSCLKin  
20% to 80%  
0.5  
1.55  
3.1  
AC coupled  
CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 0 (Bipolar)  
Clock input  
Vpp  
|V|  
Differential input voltage (see (6) and  
Figure 4)  
0.25  
0.5  
1.55  
3.1  
AC coupled  
CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 1 (MOS)  
Vpp  
(1) In order to meet the jitter performance listed in the subsequent sections of this data sheet, the minimum recommended slew rate for all  
input clocks is 0.5 V/ns. This is especially true for single-ended clocks. Phase noise performance will begin to degrade as the clock input  
slew rate is reduced. However, the device will function at slew rates down to the minimum listed. When compared to single-ended  
clocks, differential clocks (LVDS, LVPECL) will be less susceptible to degradation in phase noise performance at lower slew rates due to  
their common mode noise rejection. However, it is also recommended to use the highest possible slew rate for differential clocks to  
achieve optimal phase noise performance at the device outputs.  
(2) If emitter resistors are placed on the OSCout1/1* pins, there will be a DC current to ground which will cause powerdown Icc to increase.  
(3) Load conditions for output clocks: LVDS: 100-Ω differential. See Current Consumption and Power Dissipation Calculations for Icc for  
specific part configuration and how to calculate Icc for a specific design.  
(4) CLKin0, CLKin1 maximum is specified by characterization, production tested at 200 MHz.  
(5) Specified by characterization.  
(6) See Differential Voltage Measurement Terminology for definition of VID and VOD voltages.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
7
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Electrical Characteristics (continued)  
3.15 V VCC 3.45 V, -40 °C TA 85°C. Typical values represent most likely parametric norms at VCC = 3.3 V, TA = 25°C,  
at the Recommended Operating Conditions at the time of product characterization and are not specified.(1)  
PARAMETER  
TEST CONDITIONS  
MIN  
TYP  
MAX UNIT  
AC coupled to CLKinX; CLKinX* AC  
coupled to Ground  
CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 0 (Bipolar)  
0.25  
2.4  
2.4  
Vpp  
Vpp  
mV  
mV  
mV  
Clock input  
VCLKin  
Single-ended input voltage(5)  
AC coupled to CLKinX; CLKinX* AC  
coupled to Ground  
CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 1 (MOS)  
0.25  
DC offset voltage between  
CLKin0/CLKin0*  
CLKin0* - CLKin0  
VCLKin0-offset  
VCLKin1-offset  
VCLKinX-offset  
20  
0
Each pin AC coupled  
CLKin0_BUF_TYPE = 0 (Bipolar)  
DC offset voltage between  
CLKin1/CLKin1*  
CLKin1* - CLKin1  
DC offset voltage between  
CLKinX/CLKinX*  
Each pin AC coupled  
CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 1 (MOS)  
55  
CLKinX* - CLKinX  
VCLKin- VIH  
VCLKin- VIL  
High input voltage  
Low input voltage  
DC coupled to CLKinX; CLKinX* AC  
coupled to Ground  
CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 1 (MOS)  
2.0  
0.0  
VCC  
0.4  
V
V
FBCLKin/FBCLKin* and Fin/Fin* INPUT SPECIFICATIONS  
AC coupled  
(CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 0)  
MODE = 2 or 8; FEEDBACK_MUX =  
6
fFBCLKin  
Clock input frequency(5)  
Clock input frequency(5)  
0.001  
0.001  
1000  
MHz  
MHz  
AC coupled  
(CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 0)  
MODE = 3 or 11  
fFin  
3100  
2.0  
Single Ended  
AC coupled;  
(CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 0)  
VFBCLKin/Fin  
0.25  
0.15  
Vpp  
Clock input voltage(5)  
AC coupled; 20% to 80%;  
(CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 0)  
SLEWFBCLKin/Fin Slew rate on CLKin(5)  
0.5  
V/ns  
PLL1 SPECIFICATIONS  
fPD1  
PLL1 phase detector frequency  
40  
MHz  
µA  
VCPout1 = VCC/2, PLL1_CP_GAIN = 0  
VCPout1 = VCC/2, PLL1_CP_GAIN = 1  
VCPout1 = VCC/2, PLL1_CP_GAIN = 2  
VCPout1 = VCC/2, PLL1_CP_GAIN = 3  
VCPout1=VCC/2, PLL1_CP_GAIN = 0  
VCPout1=VCC/2, PLL1_CP_GAIN = 1  
VCPout1=VCC/2, PLL1_CP_GAIN = 2  
VCPout1=VCC/2, PLL1_CP_GAIN = 3  
100  
200  
PLL1 charge  
ICPout1SOURCE  
Pump source current(7)  
400  
1600  
-100  
-200  
-400  
-1600  
PLL1 charge  
ICPout1SINK  
µA  
Pump sink current(7)  
Charge pump  
Sink/source mismatch  
ICPout1%MIS  
ICPout1VTUNE  
ICPout1%TEMP  
ICPout1 TRI  
VCPout1 = VCC/2, T = 25 °C  
3%  
4%  
4%  
10%  
Magnitude of charge pump current  
variation vs. charge pump voltage  
0.5 V < VCPout1 < VCC - 0.5 V  
TA = 25 °C  
Charge pump current vs.  
temperature variation  
Charge Pump TRI-STATE leakage  
current  
0.5 V < VCPout < VCC - 0.5 V  
5
nA  
(7) This parameter is programmable  
8
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Electrical Characteristics (continued)  
3.15 V VCC 3.45 V, -40 °C TA 85°C. Typical values represent most likely parametric norms at VCC = 3.3 V, TA = 25°C,  
at the Recommended Operating Conditions at the time of product characterization and are not specified.(1)  
PARAMETER  
TEST CONDITIONS  
PLL1_CP_GAIN = 400 µA  
PLL1_CP_GAIN = 1600 µA  
PLL1_CP_GAIN = 400 µA  
PLL1_CP_GAIN = 1600 µA  
MIN  
TYP  
-117  
MAX UNIT  
PLL 1/f noise at 10 kHz offset.(8)  
Normalized to 1 GHz Output Frequency  
PN10kHz  
PN1Hz  
dBc/Hz  
-118  
-221.5  
-223  
Normalized phase noise contribution(9)  
dBc/Hz  
PLL2 REFERENCE INPUT (OSCin) SPECIFICATIONS  
fOSCin  
PLL2 reference input(10)  
500  
2.4  
MHz  
V/ns  
PLL2 reference clock minimum slew rate  
on OSCin(5)  
SLEWOSCin  
20% to 80%  
0.15  
0.2  
0.5  
AC coupled; Single-ended (Unused  
pin AC coupled to GND)  
VOSCin  
Input voltage for OSCin or OSCin*(5)  
Vpp  
VIDOSCin  
VSSOSCin  
0.2  
0.4  
1.55  
3.1  
|V|  
Differential voltage swing (see Figure 4) AC coupled  
Vpp  
DC offset voltage between  
VOSCin-offset  
OSCin/OSCin*  
Each pin AC coupled  
20  
mV  
OSCinX* - OSCinX  
EN_PLL2_REF_2X = 1;(11)  
OSCin Duty Cycle 40% to 60%  
fdoubler_max  
Doubler input frequency(5)  
155  
MHz  
CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR MODE SPECIFICATIONS  
fXTAL  
Crystal frequency range(5)  
RESR < 40 Ω  
6
20.5  
MHz  
µW  
Vectron VXB1 crystal, 20.48 MHz,  
RESR < 40 Ω  
XTAL_LVL = 0  
PXTAL  
Crystal power dissipation(12)  
100  
6
Input capacitance of  
LMK0480x OSCin port  
CIN  
-40 to +85 °C  
pF  
PLL2 PHASE DETECTOR and CHARGE PUMP SPECIFICATIONS  
fPD2  
Phase detector frequency  
155  
MHz  
VCPout2=VCC/2, PLL2_CP_GAIN = 0  
VCPout2=VCC/2, PLL2_CP_GAIN = 1  
VCPout2=VCC/2, PLL2_CP_GAIN = 2  
VCPout2=VCC/2, PLL2_CP_GAIN = 3  
VCPout2=VCC/2, PLL2_CP_GAIN = 0  
VCPout2=VCC/2, PLL2_CP_GAIN = 1  
VCPout2=VCC/2, PLL2_CP_GAIN = 2  
VCPout2=VCC/2, PLL2_CP_GAIN = 3  
VCPout2=VCC/2, TA = 25 °C  
100  
400  
ICPoutSOURCE  
PLL2 charge pump source current(7)  
µA  
µA  
1600  
3200  
-100  
-400  
-1600  
-3200  
3%  
ICPoutSINK  
PLL2 charge pump sink current(7)  
Charge pump sink/source mismatch  
ICPout2%MIS  
ICPout2VTUNE  
10%  
Magnitude of charge pump current vs.  
charge pump voltage variation  
0.5 V < VCPout2 < VCC - 0.5 V  
TA = 25 °C  
4%  
(8) A specification in modeling PLL in-band phase noise is the 1/f flicker noise, LPLL_flicker(f), which is dominant close to the carrier. Flicker  
noise has a 10 dB/decade slope. PN10kHz is normalized to a 10 kHz offset and a 1 GHz carrier frequency. PN10kHz = LPLL_flicker(10  
kHz) - 20log(Fout / 1 GHz), where LPLL_flicker(f) is the single side band phase noise of only the flicker noise's contribution to total noise,  
L(f). To measure LPLL_flicker(f) it is important to be on the 10 dB/decade slope close to the carrier. A high compare frequency and a clean  
crystal are important to isolating this noise source from the total phase noise, L(f). LPLL_flicker(f) can be masked by the reference  
oscillator performance if a low power or noisy source is used. The total PLL in-band phase noise performance is the sum of LPLL_flicker(f)  
and LPLL_flat(f).  
(9) A specification modeling PLL in-band phase noise. The normalized phase noise contribution of the PLL, LPLL_flat(f), is defined as:  
PN1HZ=LPLL_flat(f) - 20log(N) - 10log(fPDX). LPLL_flat(f) is the single side band phase noise measured at an offset frequency, f, in a 1 Hz  
bandwidth and fPDX is the phase detector frequency of the synthesizer. LPLL_flat(f) contributes to the total noise, L(f).  
(10) FOSCin maximum frequency specified by characterization. Production tested at 200 MHz.  
(11) The EN_PLL2_REF_2X bit (Register 13) enables/disables a frequency doubler mode for the PLL2 OSCin path.  
(12) See Application Section discussion of Optional Crystal Oscillator Implementation (OSCin/OSCin*).  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
9
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Electrical Characteristics (continued)  
3.15 V VCC 3.45 V, -40 °C TA 85°C. Typical values represent most likely parametric norms at VCC = 3.3 V, TA = 25°C,  
at the Recommended Operating Conditions at the time of product characterization and are not specified.(1)  
PARAMETER  
TEST CONDITIONS  
MIN  
TYP  
MAX UNIT  
Charge pump current vs.  
Temperature variation  
ICPout2%TEMP  
ICPout2TRI  
4%  
Charge pump leakage  
PLL 1/f Noise at 10 kHz offset(8)  
Normalized to  
0.5 V < VCPout2 < VCC - 0.5 V  
PLL2_CP_GAIN = 400 µA  
10  
nA  
-118  
-121  
PN10kHz  
PN1Hz  
dBc/Hz  
PLL2_CP_GAIN = 3200 µA  
1 GHz output frequency  
PLL2_CP_GAIN = 400 µA  
PLL2_CP_GAIN = 3200 µA  
-222.5  
-227  
Normalized Phase Noise Contribution(9)  
dBc/Hz  
MHz  
INTERNAL VCO SPECIFICATIONS  
LMK04803  
LMK04805  
LMK04806  
LMK04808  
1840  
2148  
2370  
2750  
2030  
2370  
2600  
3072  
fVCO  
VCO tuning range  
Fine tuning sensitivity  
(The range displayed in the typical  
column indicates the lower sensitivity is  
typical at the lower end of the tuning  
range, and the higher tuning sensitivity is  
typical at the higher end of the tuning  
range).  
KVCO  
LMK04808  
20 to 36  
MHz/V  
°C  
After programming R30 for lock, no  
changes to output configuration are  
permitted to ensure continuous lock  
Allowable Temperature Drift for  
Continuous Lock(13) (5)  
|ΔTCL  
|
125  
CLKout CLOSED LOOP JITTER SPECIFICATIONS USING a COMMERCIAL QUALITY VCXO(14)  
Offset = 1 kHz  
Offset = 10 kHz  
-122.5  
-132.9  
-135.2  
-143.9  
-156.0  
LMK04808  
Offset = 100 kHz  
fCLKout = 245.76 MHz  
SSB Phase noise  
Offset = 800 kHz  
L(f)CLKout  
dBc/Hz  
Offset = 10 MHz; LVDS  
Measured at clock outputs  
Value is average for all output types(15)  
Offset = 10 MHz; LVPECL 1600  
mVpp  
-157.5  
Offset = 10 MHz; LVCMOS  
BW = 12 kHz to 20 MHz  
-157.1  
112  
LMK04803(15)  
fCLKout = 245.76 MHz  
Integrated RMS jitter  
LMK04805(15)  
fCLKout = 245.76 MHz  
Integrated RMS jitter  
LMK04806(15)  
fCLKout = 245.76 MHz  
Integrated RMS jitter  
LMK04808(15)  
fCLKout = 245.76 MHz  
Integrated RMS jitter  
BW = 100 Hz to 20 MHz  
BW = 12 kHz to 20 MHz  
BW = 100 Hz to 20 MHz  
BW = 12 kHz to 20 MHz  
BW = 100 Hz to 20 MHz  
BW = 12 kHz to 20 MHz  
BW = 100 Hz to 20 MHz  
121  
113  
122  
115  
123  
111  
123  
JCLKout  
LVDS/LVPECL/  
LVCMOS  
fs rms  
(13) Maximum Allowable Temperature Drift for Continuous Lock is how far the temperature can drift in either direction from the value it was  
at the time that the R30 register was last programmed, and still have the part stay in lock. The action of programming the R30 register,  
even to the same value, activates a frequency calibration routine. This implies the part will work over the entire frequency range, but if  
the temperature drifts more than the maximum allowable drift for continuous lock, then it will be necessary to reload the R30 register to  
ensure it stays in lock. Regardless of what temperature the part was initially programmed at, the temperature can never drift outside the  
frequency range of -40 °C to 85 °C without violating specifications.  
(14) VCXO used is a 122.88 MHz Crystek CVHD-950-122.880.  
(15) fVCO = 2949.12 MHz, PLL1 parameters: FPD1 = 1.024 MHz, ICP1 = 100 μA, loop bandwidth = 10 Hz. 122.88 MHz Crystek CVHD-  
950–122.880. PLL2 parameters: PLL2_R = 1, FPD2 = 122.88 MHz, ICP2 = 3200 μA, C1 = 47 pF, C2 = 3.9 nF, R2 = 620 , PLL2_C3_LF  
= 0, PLL2_R3_LF = 0, PLL2_C4_LF = 0, PLL2_R4_LF = 0, CLKoutX_Y_DIV = 12, and CLKoutX_ADLY_SEL = 0.  
10  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Electrical Characteristics (continued)  
3.15 V VCC 3.45 V, -40 °C TA 85°C. Typical values represent most likely parametric norms at VCC = 3.3 V, TA = 25°C,  
at the Recommended Operating Conditions at the time of product characterization and are not specified.(1)  
PARAMETER  
TEST CONDITIONS  
MIN  
TYP  
MAX UNIT  
(16)  
CLKout CLOSED LOOP JITTER SPECIFICATIONS USING THE INTEGRATED LOW NOISE CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR CIRCUIT  
BW = 12 kHz to 20 MHz  
XTAL_LVL = 3  
192  
450  
LMK04808  
fCLKout = 245.76 MHz  
Integrated RMS jitter  
fs rms  
MHz  
BW = 100 Hz to 20 MHz  
XTAL_LVL = 3  
DEFAULT POWER ON RESET CLOCK OUTPUT FREQUENCY  
CLKout8, LVDS, LMK04803  
69  
80  
90  
90  
77  
90  
87  
99  
CLKout8, LVDS, LMK04805  
CLKout8, LVDS, LMK04806  
CLKout8, LVDS, LMK04808  
Default output clock frequency at device  
power on(17)  
fCLKout-startup  
98  
110  
130  
110  
CLOCK SKEW and DELAY  
LVDS-to-LVDS, T = 25 °C,  
FCLK = 800 MHz, RL= 100 Ω  
AC coupled  
30  
30  
LVPECL-to-LVPECL,  
T = 25 °C,  
FCLK = 800 MHz, RL= 100 Ω  
emitter resistors =  
240 Ω to GND  
Maximum CLKoutX to CLKoutY(5)(18)  
|TSKEW  
|
ps  
AC coupled  
Maximum skew between any two  
LVCMOS outputs, same CLKout or  
different CLKout(5)(18)  
RL = 50 Ω, CL = 5 pF,  
T = 25 °C, FCLK = 100 MHz.  
100  
Same device, T = 25 °C,  
250 MHz  
MixedTSKEW  
LVDS or LVPECL to LVCMOS  
750  
ps  
ps  
MODE = 2  
PLL1_R_DLY = 0; PLL1_N_DLY = 0  
1850  
MODE = 2  
PLL1_R_DLY = 0; PLL1_N_DLY = 0;  
VCO Frequency = 2949.12 MHz  
Analog delay select = 0;  
Feedback clock digital delay = 11;  
Feedback clock half step = 1;  
Output clock digital delay = 5;  
Output clock half step = 0;  
td0-DELAY  
CLKin to CLKoutX delay(18)  
0
(16) Crystal used is a 20.48 MHz Vectron VXB1-1150-20M480 and Skyworks varactor diode, SMV-1249-074LF.  
(17) CLKout6 and OSCout0 also oscillate at start-up at the frequency of the VCXO attached to OSCin port.  
(18) Equal loading and identical clock output configuration on each clock output is required for specification to be valid. Specification is not  
valid for CLKoutX or CLKoutY in analog delay mode.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
11  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Electrical Characteristics (continued)  
3.15 V VCC 3.45 V, -40 °C TA 85°C. Typical values represent most likely parametric norms at VCC = 3.3 V, TA = 25°C,  
at the Recommended Operating Conditions at the time of product characterization and are not specified.(1)  
PARAMETER  
TEST CONDITIONS  
MIN  
TYP  
MAX UNIT  
LVDS CLOCK OUTPUTS (CLKoutX), CLKoutX_TYPE = 1  
fCLKout  
VOD  
Maximum frequency(5)(19)  
RL = 100 Ω  
1536  
250  
MHz  
400  
800  
450  
|mV|  
Differential output voltage (see Figure 5)  
VSS  
500  
900 mVpp  
Change in magnitude of VOD for  
complementary output states  
T = 25 °C, DC measurement  
AC coupled to receiver input  
R = 100-Ω differential termination  
ΔVOD  
VOS  
-50  
50  
1.375  
35  
mV  
V
Output offset voltage  
1.125  
1.25  
200  
Change in VOS for complementary output  
states  
ΔVOS  
|mV|  
Output rise time  
Output fall time  
20% to 80%, RL = 100 Ω  
80% to 20%, RL = 100 Ω  
TR / TF  
ps  
ISA  
ISB  
Output short circuit current  
single ended  
Single-ended output shorted to GND  
T = 25 °C  
-24  
-12  
24  
12  
mA  
mA  
ISAB  
Output short circuit current - differential  
Complimentary outputs tied together  
LVPECL CLOCK OUTPUTS (CLKoutX)  
fCLKout  
Maximum frequency(5)(19)  
1536  
MHz  
ps  
20% to 80% output rise  
RL = 100 Ω, emitter resistors = 240 Ω  
to GND  
CLKoutX_TYPE = 4 or 5  
(1600 or 2000 mVpp)  
TR / TF  
150  
80% to 20% output fall time  
700 mVpp LVPECL CLOCK OUTPUTS (CLKoutX), CLKoutX_TYPE = 2  
VCC  
1.03  
-
VOH  
VOL  
Output high voltage  
Output low voltage  
V
T = 25 °C, DC measurement  
Termination = 50 Ω to  
VCC - 1.4 V  
VCC  
1.41  
-
V
VOD  
VSS  
305  
610  
380  
760  
440  
|mV|  
Output voltage (see Figure 5)  
880 mVpp  
1200 mVpp LVPECL CLOCK OUTPUTS (CLKoutX), CLKoutX_TYPE = 3  
VCC  
1.07  
-
VOH  
VOL  
Output high voltage  
Output low voltage  
V
V
T = 25 °C, DC measurement  
Termination = 50 Ω to  
VCC - 1.7 V  
VCC  
1.69  
-
VOD  
VSS  
545  
625  
705  
|mV|  
Output voltage (see Figure 5)  
1090  
1250  
1410 mVpp  
1600 mVpp LVPECL CLOCK OUTPUTS (CLKoutX), CLKoutX_TYPE = 4  
VCC  
1.10  
-
VOH  
VOL  
Output high voltage  
Output low voltage  
V
V
T = 25 °C, DC Measurement  
Termination = 50 Ω to  
VCC - 2.0 V  
VCC  
1.97  
-
VOD  
VSS  
660  
870  
965  
|mV|  
Output voltage (see Figure 5)  
1320  
1740  
1930 mVpp  
2000 mVpp LVPECL (2VPECL) CLOCK OUTPUTS (CLKoutX), CLKoutX_TYPE = 5  
VCC  
1.13  
-
VOH  
VOL  
Output high voltage  
Output low voltage  
V
V
T = 25 °C, DC Measurement  
Termination = 50 Ω to  
VCC - 2.3 V  
VCC  
2.20  
-
VOD  
VSS  
800  
1070  
2140  
1200  
|mV|  
Output voltage Figure 5  
1600  
2400 mVpp  
(19) Refer to Typical Characteristics: Clock Output AC Characteristics for output operation performance at higher frequencies than the  
minimum maximum output frequency.  
12  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Electrical Characteristics (continued)  
3.15 V VCC 3.45 V, -40 °C TA 85°C. Typical values represent most likely parametric norms at VCC = 3.3 V, TA = 25°C,  
at the Recommended Operating Conditions at the time of product characterization and are not specified.(1)  
PARAMETER  
LVCMOS CLOCK OUTPUTS (CLKoutX)  
TEST CONDITIONS  
MIN  
TYP  
MAX UNIT  
fCLKout  
Maximum frequency(5)(19)  
5 pF Load  
250  
MHz  
V
VCC  
-
VOH  
Output high voltage  
1 mA Load  
0.1  
VOL  
IOH  
IOL  
Output low voltage  
1 mA Load  
0.1  
V
Output high current (source)  
Output low current (sink)  
VCC = 3.3 V, VO = 1.65 V  
VCC = 3.3 V, VO = 1.65 V  
28  
28  
mA  
mA  
VCC/2 to VCC/2, FCLK = 100 MHz  
T = 25 °C  
DUTYCLK  
Output duty cycle(5)  
Output rise time  
Output fall time  
45%  
50%  
400  
400  
55%  
20% to 80%, RL = 50 Ω,  
CL = 5 pF  
TR  
TF  
ps  
ps  
80% to 20%, RL = 50 Ω,  
CL = 5 pF  
DIGITAL OUTPUTS (Status_CLKinX, Status_LD, Status_Holdover, SYNC)  
VCC  
0.4  
-
VOH  
High-Level output voltage  
IOH = -500 µA  
IOL = 500 µA  
V
V
VOL  
Low-Level output voltage  
0.4  
DIGITAL INPUTS (Status_CLKinX, SYNC)  
VIH  
VIL  
High-Level input voltage  
Low-Level input voltage  
1.6  
VCC  
0.4  
V
V
Status_CLKinX_TYPE = 0  
(High Impedance)  
-5  
-5  
5
5
High-Level input current  
VIH = VCC  
Status_CLKinX_TYPE = 1  
(Pull-up)  
IIH  
µA  
µA  
Status_CLKinX_TYPE = 2  
(Pull-down)  
10  
-5  
80  
5
Status_CLKinX_TYPE = 0  
(High Impedance)  
Low-Level input current  
VIL = 0 V  
Status_CLKinX_TYPE = 1  
(Pull-up)  
IIL  
-40  
-5  
-5  
5
Status_CLKinX_TYPE = 2  
(Pull-down)  
DIGITAL INPUTS (CLKuWire, DATAuWire, LEuWire)  
VIH  
VIL  
IIH  
High-Level input voltage  
Low-Level input voltage  
High-Level input current  
Low-Level input current  
1.6  
VCC  
0.4  
25  
5
V
V
VIH = VCC  
VIL = 0  
5
µA  
µA  
IIL  
-5  
6.6 Timing Requirements  
See Serial MICROWIRE Timing Diagram and Advanced MICROWIRE Timing Diagrams for additional information  
MIN  
25  
25  
8
NOM  
MAX UNIT  
TECS  
TDCS  
TCDH  
TCWH  
TCWL  
TCES  
TEWH  
TCR  
LE to Clock Set Up Time  
Data to Clock Set Up Time  
Clock to Data Hold Time  
Clock Pulse Width High  
Clock Pulse Width Low  
Clock to LE Set Up Time  
LE Pulse Width  
See Figure 6  
See Figure 6  
See Figure 6  
See Figure 6  
See Figure 6  
See Figure 6  
See Figure 6  
See Figure 9  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
25  
25  
25  
25  
25  
Falling Clock to Readback Time  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
13  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
6.7 Typical Characteristics: Clock Output AC Characteristics  
500  
450  
400  
350  
300  
250  
200  
150  
100  
50  
1200  
2000 mVpp  
1600 mVpp  
1200 mVpp  
700 mVpp  
1000  
800  
600  
400  
200  
0
0
0
500 1000 1500 2000 2500 3000  
FREQUENCY (MHz)  
0
500 1000 1500 2000 2500 3000  
FREQUENCY (MHz)  
Figure 1. LVDS VOD vs. Frequency  
Figure 2. LVPECL /w 240-Ω Emitter Resistors VOD vs.  
Frequency  
1200  
1000  
800  
600  
400  
200  
0
2000 mVpp  
1600 mVpp  
0
500 1000 1500 2000 2500 3000  
FREQUENCY (MHz)  
Figure 3. LVPECL /w 120-Ω Emitter Resistors VOD vs. Frequency  
14  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
7 Parameter Measurement Information  
7.1 Charge Pump Current Specification Definitions  
I1 = Charge Pump Sink Current at VCPout = VCC - ΔV  
I2 = Charge Pump Sink Current at VCPout = VCC/2  
I3 = Charge Pump Sink Current at VCPout = ΔV  
I4 = Charge Pump Source Current at VCPout = VCC - ΔV  
I5 = Charge Pump Source Current at VCPout = VCC/2  
I6 = Charge Pump Source Current at VCPout = ΔV  
ΔV = Voltage offset from the positive and negative supply rails. Defined to be 0.5 V for this device.  
7.1.1 Charge Pump Output Current Magnitude Variation Vs. Charge Pump Output Voltage  
7.1.2 Charge Pump Sink Current Vs. Charge Pump Output Source Current Mismatch  
7.1.3 Charge Pump Output Current Magnitude Variation vs. Ambient Temperature  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
15  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
7.2 Differential Voltage Measurement Terminology  
The differential voltage of a differential signal can be described by two different definitions causing confusion  
when reading datasheets or communicating with other engineers. This section will address the measurement and  
description of a differential signal so that the reader will be able to understand and discern between the two  
different definitions when used.  
The first definition used to describe a differential signal is the absolute value of the voltage potential between the  
inverting and non-inverting signal. The symbol for this first measurement is typically VID or VOD depending on if  
an input or output voltage is being described.  
The second definition used to describe a differential signal is to measure the potential of the non-inverting signal  
with respect to the inverting signal. The symbol for this second measurement is VSS and is a calculated  
parameter. Nowhere in the IC does this signal exist with respect to ground, it only exists in reference to its  
differential pair. VSS can be measured directly by oscilloscopes with floating references, otherwise this value can  
be calculated as twice the value of VOD as described in the first description.  
Figure 4 illustrates the two different definitions side-by-side for inputs and Figure 5 illustrates the two different  
definitions side-by-side for outputs. The VID and VOD definitions show VA and VB DC levels that the non-inverting  
and inverting signals toggle between with respect to ground. VSS input and output definitions show that if the  
inverting signal is considered the voltage potential reference, the non-inverting signal voltage potential is now  
increasing and decreasing above and below the non-inverting reference. Thus the peak-to-peak voltage of the  
differential signal can be measured.  
VID and VOD are often defined as volts (V) and VSS is often defined as volts peak-to-peak (VPP).  
V
ID  
Definition  
V
Definition for Input  
SS  
Non-Inverting Clock  
V
V
A
B
2·V  
V
ID  
ID  
Inverting Clock  
= | V - V  
V
|
B
V
SS  
= 2·V  
ID  
ID  
A
GND  
Figure 4. Two Different Definitions for Differential Input Signals  
V
Definition  
V
Definition for Output  
SS  
OD  
Non-Inverting Clock  
V
V
A
B
2·V  
V
OD  
OD  
Inverting Clock  
= | V - V  
V
|
B
V
SS  
= 2·V  
OD  
OD  
A
GND  
Figure 5. Two Different Definitions for Differential Output Signals  
Refer to Application Note AN-912, Common Data Transmission Parameters and their Definitions (SNLA036) for  
more information.  
16  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8 Detailed Description  
8.1 Overview  
In default mode of operation, dual PLL mode with internal VCO, the Phase Frequency Detector in PLL1  
compares the active CLKinX reference divided by CLKinX_PreR_DIV and PLL1 R divider with the external  
VCXO or crystal attached to the PLL2 OSCin port divided by PLL1 N divider. The external loop filter for PLL1  
should be narrow to provide an ultra clean reference clock from the external VCXO or crystal to the  
OSCin/OSCin* pins for PLL2.  
The Phase Frequency Detector in PLL2 compares the external VCXO or crystal to the internal VCO after the  
reference and feedback dividers. The VCXO or crystal on the OSCin input is divided by PLL2 R divider. The  
feedback from the internal VCO is divided by the PLL2 Prescaler, the PLL2 N divider, and optionally the VCO  
divider.  
The bandwidth of the external loop filter for PLL2 should be designed to be wide enough to take advantage of  
the low in-band phase noise of PLL2 and the low high offset phase noise of the internal VCO. The VCO output is  
also placed on the distribution path for the Clock Distribution section. The clock distribution consists of 6 groups  
of dividers and delays which drive 12 outputs. Each clock group allows the user to select a divide value, a digital  
delay value, and an analog delay. The 6 groups drive programmable output buffers. Two groups allow their input  
signal to be from the OSCin port directly.  
When a 0-delay mode is used, a clock output will be passed through the feedback mux to the PLL1 N Divider for  
synchronization and 0-delay.  
When an external VCO mode is used, the Fin port will be used to input an external VCO signal. PLL2 Phase  
comparison will now be with this signal divided by the PLL2 N divider and N2 pre-scaler. The VCO divider may  
not be used. One less clock input is available when using an external VCO mode.  
When a single PLL mode is used, PLL1 is powered down. OSCin is used as a reference to PLL2.  
8.1.1 System Architecture  
The dual loop PLL architecture of the LMK0480x provides the lowest jitter performance over the widest range of  
output frequencies and phase noise integration bandwidths. The first stage PLL (PLL1) is driven by an external  
reference clock and uses an external VCXO or tunable crystal to provide a frequency accurate, low phase noise  
reference clock for the second stage frequency multiplication PLL (PLL2). PLL1 typically uses a narrow loop  
bandwidth (10 Hz to 200 Hz) to retain the frequency accuracy of the reference clock input signal while at the  
same time suppressing the higher offset frequency phase noise that the reference clock may have accumulated  
along its path or from other circuits. This “cleaned” reference clock provides the reference input to PLL2.  
The low phase noise reference provided to PLL2 allows PLL2 to operate with a wide loop bandwidth (50 kHz to  
200 kHz). The loop bandwidth for PLL2 is chosen to take advantage of the superior high offset frequency phase  
noise profile of the internal VCO and the good low offset frequency phase noise of the reference VCXO or  
tunable crystal.  
Ultra low jitter is achieved by allowing the external VCXO or crystal’s phase noise to dominate the final output  
phase noise at low offset frequencies and the internal (or external) VCO’s phase noise to dominate the final  
output phase noise at high offset frequencies. This results in best overall phase noise and jitter performance.  
The LMK0480x allows subsets of the device to be used to increase the flexibility of device. These different  
modes are selected using MODE: Device Mode. For instance:  
Dual Loop Mode - Typical use case of LMK04808. CLKinX used as reference input to PLL1, OSCin port is  
connected to VCXO or tunable crystal.  
Single Loop Mode - Powers down PLL1. OSCin port is used as reference input.  
Clock Distribution Mode - Allows input of CLKin1 to be distributed to output with division, digital delay, and  
analog delay.  
See Device Functional Modes for more information on these modes.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
17  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Overview (continued)  
8.1.2 PLL1 Redundant Reference Inputs (CLKin0/CLKin0* and CLKin1/CLKin1*)  
The LMK0480x has two reference clock inputs for PLL1: CLKin0 and CLKin1. Ref Mux selects CLKin0 or  
CLKin1. Automatic or manual switching occurs between the inputs.  
CLKin0 and CLKin1 each have input dividers. The input divider allows different clock input frequencies to be  
normalized so that the frequency input to the PLL1 R divider remains constant during automatic switching. By  
programming these dividers such that the frequency presented to the input of the PLL1_R divider is the same  
prevents the user from needing to reprogram the PLL1 R divider when the input reference is changed to another  
CLKin port with a different frequency.  
CLKin1 is shared for use as an external 0-delay feedback (FBCLKin), or for use with an external VCO (Fin).  
Fast manual switching between reference clocks is possible with external pins Status_CLKin0 and  
Status_CLKin1.  
8.1.3 PLL1 Tunable Crystal Support  
The LMK0480x integrates a crystal oscillator on PLL1 for use with an external crystal and varactor diode to  
perform jitter cleaning.  
The LMK0480x must be programmed to enable Crystal mode.  
8.1.4 VCXO/CRYSTAL Buffered Outputs  
The LMK0480x provides 2 dedicated outputs which are a buffered copy of the PLL2 reference input. This  
reference input is typically a low noise VCXO or Crystal. When using a VCXO, this output can be used to clock  
external devices such as microcontrollers, FPGAs, CPLDs, and so forth, before the LMK0480x is programmed.  
The OSCout0 buffer output type is programmable to LVDS, LVPECL, or LVCMOS. The OSCout1 buffer is fixed  
to LVPECL.  
The dedicated output buffers OSCout0 and OSCout1 can output frequency lower than the VCXO or Crystal  
frequency by programming the OSC Divider. The OSC Divider value range is 2 to 8. Each OSCoutX can  
individually choose to use the OSC Divider output or to bypass the OSC Divider.  
Two clock output groups can also be programmed to be driven by OSCin. This allows a total of 4 additional  
differential outputs to be buffered outputs of OSCin. When programmed in this way, a total of 6 differential  
outputs can be driven by a buffered copy of OSCin.  
VCXO/Crystal buffered outputs cannot be synchronized to the VCO clock distribution outputs. The assertion of  
SYNC will still cause these outputs to become low temporarily. Since these outputs will turn off and on  
asynchronously with respect to the VCO sourced clock outputs during a SYNC, it is possible for glitches to occur  
on the buffered clock outputs when SYNC is asserted and unasserted. If the NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bits are set  
these outputs will not be affected by the SYNC event except that the phase relationship will change with the  
other synchronized clocks unless a buffered clock output is used as a qualification clock during SYNC.  
8.1.5 Frequency Holdover  
The LMK0480x supports holdover operation to keep the clock outputs on frequency with minimum drift when the  
reference is lost until a valid reference clock signal is re-established.  
8.1.6 Integrated Loop Filter Poles  
The LMK0480x features programmable 3rd and 4th order loop filter poles for PLL2. These internal resistors and  
capacitor values may be selected from a fixed range of values to achieve either a 3rd or 4th order loop filter  
response. The integrated programmable resistors and capacitors compliment external components mounted near  
the chip.  
These integrated components can be effectively disabled by programming the integrated resistors and capacitors  
to their minimum values.  
18  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Overview (continued)  
8.1.7 Internal VCO  
The output of the internal VCO is routed to a mux which allows the user to select either the direct VCO output or  
a divided version of the VCO for the Clock Distribution Path. This same selection is also fed back to the PLL2  
phase detector through a prescaler and N-divider.  
The mux selectable VCO divider has a divide range of 2 to 8 with 50% output duty cycle for both even and odd  
divide values.  
The primary use of the VCO divider is to achieve divides greater than the clock output divider supports alone.  
8.1.8 External VCO Mode  
The Fin/Fin* input allows an external VCO to be used with PLL2 of the LMK0480x.  
Using an external VCO reduces the number of available clock inputs by one.  
8.1.9 Clock Distribution  
The LMK0480x features a total of 12 outputs driven from the internal or external VCO.  
All VCO driven outputs have programmable output types. They can be programmed to LVPECL, LVDS, or  
LVCMOS. When all distribution outputs are configured for LVCMOS or single ended LVPECL a total of 24  
outputs are available.  
If the buffered OSCin outputs OSCout0 and OSCout1 are included in the total number of clock outputs the  
LMK0480x is able to distribute, then up to 14 differential clocks or up to 28 single ended clocks may be  
generated with the LMK0480x.  
The following sections discuss specific features of the clock distribution channels that allow the user to control  
various aspects of the output clocks.  
8.1.9.1 CLKout DIVIDER  
Each clock group, which is a pair of outputs such as CLKout0 and CLKout1, has a single clock output divider.  
The divider supports a divide range of 1 to 1045 (even and odd) with 50% output duty cycle. When divides of 26  
or greater are used, the divider/delay block uses extended mode.  
The VCO Divider may be used to reduce the divide needed by the clock group divider so that it may operate in  
normal mode instead of extended mode. This can result in a small current saving if enabling the VCO Divider  
allows 3 or more clock output divides to change from extended to normal mode.  
8.1.9.2 CLKout Delay  
See Clock Distribution section for details on both a fine (analog) and coarse (digital) delay for phase adjustment  
of the clock outputs.  
The fine (analog) delay allows a nominal 25 ps step size and range from 0 to 475 ps of total delay. Enabling the  
analog delay adds a nominal 500 ps of delay in addition to the programmed value. When adjusting analog delay,  
glitches may occur on the clock outputs being adjusted. Analog delay may not operate at frequencies above the  
minimum-ensured maximum output frequency of 1536 MHz.  
The coarse (digital) delay allows a group of outputs to be delayed by 4.5 to 12 clock distribution path cycles in  
normal mode, or from 12.5 to 522 VCO cycles in extended mode. The delay step can be as small as half the  
period of the clock distribution path by using the CLKoutX_Y_HS bit provided the output divide value is greater  
than 1. For example, a 2-GHz VCO frequency without the use of the VCO divider results in 250 ps coarse tuning  
steps.. The coarse (digital) delay value takes effect on the clock outputs after a SYNC event.  
There are 3 different ways to use the digital (coarse) delay:  
1. Fixed Digital Delay  
2. Absolute Dynamic Digital Delay  
3. Relative Dynamic Digital Delay  
These are further discussed in Clock Distribution.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
19  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Overview (continued)  
8.1.9.3 Programmable Output Type  
For increased flexibility all LMK0480x clock outputs (CLKoutX) and OSCout0 can be programmed to an LVDS,  
LVPECL, or LVCMOS output type. OSCout1 is fixed as LVPECL.  
Any LVPECL output type can be programmed to 700, 1200, 1600, or 2000 mVpp amplitude levels. The 2000  
mVpp LVPECL output type is a Texas Instruments proprietary configuration that produces a 2000 mVpp  
differential swing for compatibility with many data converters and is also known as 2VPECL.  
8.1.9.4 Clock Output Synchronization  
Using the SYNC input causes all active clock outputs to share a rising edge. See Clock Output Synchronization  
(SYNC) for more information.  
The SYNC event also causes the digital delay values to take effect.  
8.1.10 0-Delay  
The 0-delay mode synchronizes the input clock phase to the output clock phase. The 0-delay feedback may be  
performed with an internal feedback loop from any of the clock groups or with an external feedback loop into the  
FBCLKin port as selected by the FEEDBACK_MUX.  
Without using 0-delay mode there will be D possible fixed phase relationships from clock input to clock output  
depending on the clock output divide value.  
Using an external 0-delay feedback reduces the number of available clock inputs by one.  
8.1.11 Default Startup Clocks  
Before the LMK0480x is programmed, CLKout8 is enabled and operating at a nominal frequency and CLKout6  
and OSCout0 are enabled and operating at the OSCin frequency. These clocks can be used to clock external  
devices such as microcontrollers, FPGAs, CPLDs, and so forth, before the LMK0480x is programmed.  
For CLKout6 and OSCout0 to work before the LMK0480x is programmed, the device must not be using Crystal  
mode.  
8.1.12 Status Pins  
The LMK0480x provides status pins which can be monitored for feedback or in some cases used for input  
depending upon device programming. For example:  
The Status_Holdover pin may indicate if the device is in hold-over mode.  
The Status_CLKin0 pin may indicate the LOS (loss-of-signal) for CLKin0.  
The Status_CLKin0 pin may be an input for selecting the active clock input.  
The Status_LD pin may indicate if the device is locked.  
The status pins can be programmed to a variety of other outputs including analog lock detect, PLL divider  
outputs, combined PLL lock detect signals, PLL1 Vtune railing, readback, and so forth. Refer to the Programming  
of this datasheet for more information. Default pin programming is captured in Table 18.  
8.1.13 Register Readback  
Programmed registers may be read back using the MICROWIRE interface. For readback, one of the status pins  
must be programmed for readback mode.  
At no time may registers be programed to values other than the valid states defined in the datasheet.  
20  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.2 Functional Block Diagram  
CLKin0 Divider  
(1, 2, 4, or 8)  
Ref  
Mux  
R1 Divider  
(1 to 16,383)  
CLKin0*  
CLKin0  
Status_LD  
R Delay  
N Delay  
Phase  
Detector  
PLL1  
Device  
Control  
Status_Holdover  
Status_CLKin0  
Status_CLKin1  
SYNC  
CLKin1*/Fin*  
FBCLKin*  
CLKin1/  
CLKin1 Divider  
(1, 2, 4, or 8)  
N1 Divider  
(1 to 16,383)  
Fin/FBCLKin  
Fin/Fin*  
FBMux  
CLKuWire  
DATAuWire  
LEuWire  
PWire  
CLKout0  
CLKout2  
CLKout4  
CLKout6  
CLKout8  
CLKout10  
Control  
Holdover  
Port  
Registers  
FB  
Mux  
Mode  
Mux2  
2X  
Partially  
Integrated  
Loop Filter  
2X  
Mux  
R2 Divider  
(1 to 4,095)  
Internal VCO  
Phase  
Detector  
PLL2  
OSCout0  
OSCout0*  
OSC Divider  
(2 to 8)  
OSCout0  
_MUX  
N2 Divider  
Mode  
Mux3  
FBMux  
(1 to 262,143)  
OSCout1  
OSCout1*  
OSCout1  
_MUX  
VCO  
Mux  
VCO Divider  
(2 to 8)  
N2 Prescaler  
(2 to 8)  
Clock Distribution Path Mode  
Mux1  
OSCin*  
OSCin  
Fin/Fin*  
CLKout6  
CLKout6*  
Clock Group 3  
CLKout0  
CLKout0*  
Mux  
Mux  
Osc  
Mux1  
Divider  
(1 to 1045)  
Digital  
Delay  
Digital  
Delay  
Divider  
(1 to 1045)  
Clock Group 0  
Delay  
Delay  
Delay  
Delay  
CLKout1  
CLKout1*  
CLKout7  
CLKout7*  
Mux  
Mux  
Mux  
Mux  
Clock Buffer 1  
CLKout2  
CLKout2*  
CLKout8  
CLKout8*  
Osc  
Mux2  
Digital  
Delay  
Digital  
Delay  
Divider  
(1 to 1045)  
Divider  
(1 to 1045)  
Clock Group 1  
Clock Group 4  
Delay  
Delay  
CLKout3  
CLKout3*  
CLKout9  
CLKout9*  
Mux  
Mux  
Mux  
Mux  
Clock Buffer 3  
CLKout4  
CLKout4*  
CLKout10  
CLKout10*  
Divider  
(1 to 1045)  
Digital  
Delay  
Digital  
Delay  
Divider  
(1 to 1045)  
Clock Group 2  
Clock Group 5  
CLKout5  
CLKout5*  
CLKout11  
CLKout11*  
Mux  
Mux  
Clock Buffer 2  
Clock Buffer 1  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
21  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.3 Feature Description  
8.3.1 Serial MICROWIRE Timing Diagram  
For timing specifications, see Timing Requirements. Register programming information on the DATAuWire pin is  
clocked into a shift register on each rising edge of the CLKuWire signal. On the rising edge of the LEuWire  
signal, the register is sent from the shift register to the register addressed. A slew rate of at least 30 V/µs is  
recommended for these signals. After programming is complete the CLKuWire, DATAuWire, and LEuWire  
signals should be returned to a low state. If the CLKuWire or DATAuWire lines are toggled while the VCO is in  
lock, as is sometimes the case when these lines are shared with other parts, the phase noise may be degraded  
during this programming.  
MSB  
D26  
LSB  
A0  
DATAuWire  
CLKuWire  
LEuWire  
D25  
D24  
D23  
D22  
D0  
A4  
A1  
t
CES  
t
ECS  
t
ECS  
t
t
CWL  
CWH  
t
t
CDH  
DCS  
t
EWH  
Figure 6. MICROWIRE Input Timing Diagram  
8.3.2 Advanced MICROWIRE Timing Diagrams  
8.3.2.1 Three Extra Clocks or Double Program  
For timing specifications, see Timing Requirements. Figure 7 shows the timing for the programming sequence for  
loading CLKoutX_Y_DIV > 25 or CLKoutX_Y_DDLY > 12 as described in Special Programming Case for R0 to  
R5 for CLKoutX_Y_DIV and CLKoutX_Y_DDLY.  
MSB  
D26  
LSB  
A0  
DATAuWire  
CLKuWire  
LEuWire  
t
ECS  
t
CES  
t
t
CWH  
CWL  
t
EWH  
Figure 7. MICROWIRE Timing Diagram: Extra CLKuWire Pulses for R0 to R5  
22  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Feature Description (continued)  
8.3.2.2 Three Extra Clocks with LEuWire High  
For timing specifications, see Timing Requirements. Figure 8 shows the timing for the programming sequence  
which allows SYNC_EN_AUTO = 1 when loading CLKoutX_Y_DIV > 25 or CLKoutX_Y_DDLY > 12. When  
SYNC_EN_AUTO = 1, a SYNC event is automatically generated on the falling edge of LEuWire. See Special  
Programming Case for R0 to R5 for CLKoutX_Y_DIV and CLKoutX_Y_DDLY.  
MSB  
D26  
LSB  
A0  
DATAuWire  
CLKuWire  
LEuWire  
t
ECS  
t
CES  
t
CES  
Figure 8. MICROWIRE Timing Diagram: Extra CLKuWire Pulses for R0 to R5 with LEuWire Asserted  
8.3.2.3 Readback  
For timing specifications, see Timing Requirements. See Readback for more information on performing a  
readback operation. Figure 9 shows timing for LEuWire for both READBACK_LE = 1 and 0.  
The rising edges of CLKuWire during MICROWIRE readback continue to clock data on DATAuWire into the  
device during readback. If after the readback, LEuWire transitions from low to high, this data will be latched to  
the decoded register. The decoded register address consists of the last 5 bits clocked on DATAuWire as shown  
in Figure 9.  
MSB  
D26  
LSB  
A0  
DATAuWire  
CLKuWire  
t
CR  
t
ECS  
t
CWH  
t
CR  
t
CWL  
LEuWire  
t
CES  
READBACK_LE = 0  
t
EWH  
t
ECS  
LEuWire  
READBACK_LE = 1  
Readback Pin  
RD26  
RD25  
RD24  
RD23  
RD0  
Register Write  
Register Read  
Figure 9. MICROWIRE Readback Timing Diagram  
8.3.3 Inputs / Outputs  
8.3.3.1 PLL1 Reference Inputs (CLKin0 and CLKin1)  
The reference clock inputs for PLL1 may be selected from either CLKin0 or CLKin1. The user has the capability  
to manually select one of the inputs or to configure an automatic switching mode of operation. See Input Clock  
Switching for more info.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
23  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Feature Description (continued)  
CLKin0 and CLKin1 have dividers which allow the device to switch between reference inputs of different  
frequencies automatically without needing to reprogram the PLL1 R divider. The CLKin pre-divider values are 1,  
2, 4, and 8.  
CLKin1 input can alternatively be used for external feedback in 0-delay mode (FBCLKin) or for an external VCO  
input port (Fin).  
8.3.3.2 PLL2 OSCin / OSCin* Port  
The feedback from the external oscillator being locked with PLL1 drives the OSCin/OSCin* pins. Internally this  
signal is routed to the PLL1 N Divider and to the reference input for PLL2.  
This input may be driven with either a single-ended or differential signal and must be AC coupled. If operated in  
single ended mode, the unused input must be connected to GND with a 0.1 µF capacitor.  
8.3.3.3 Crystal Oscillator  
The internal circuitry of the OSCin port also supports the optional implementation of a crystal based oscillator  
circuit. A crystal, a varactor diode, and a small number of other external components may be used to implement  
the oscillator. The internal oscillator circuit is enabled by setting the EN_PLL2_XTAL bit. See EN_PLL2_XTAL.  
8.3.4 Input Clock Switching  
Manual, pin select, and automatic are three different kinds clock input switching modes can be set with the  
CLKin_SELECT_MODE register.  
Below is information about how the active input clock is selected and what causes a switching event in the  
various clock input selection modes.  
8.3.4.1 Input Clock Switching - Manual Mode  
When CLKin_SELECT_MODE is 0 or 1 then CLKin0 or CLKin1 respectively is always selected as the active  
input clock. Manual mode will also override the EN_CLKinX bits such that the CLKinX buffer will operate even if  
CLKinX is disabled with EN_CLKinX = 0.  
Entering Holdover: If holdover mode is enabled, then holdover mode is entered if Digital lock detect of PLL1  
goes low and DISABLE_DLD1_DET = 0.  
Exiting Holdover: The active clock for automatic exit of holdover mode is the manually selected clock input.  
8.3.4.2 Input Clock Switching - Pin Select Mode  
When CLKin_SELECT_MODE is 3, the pins Status_CLKin0 and Status_CLKin1 select which clock input is  
active.  
Clock Switch Event: Pins: Changing the state of Status_CLKin0 or Status_CLKin1 pins causes an input  
clock switch event.  
Clock Switch Event: PLL1 DLD: To prevent PLL1 DLD high to low transition from causing a input clock  
switch event and causing the device to enter holdover mode, disable the PLL1 DLD detect by setting  
DISABLE_DLD1_DET = 1. This is the preferred behavior for Pin Select Mode.  
Configuring Pin Select Mode:  
The Status_CLKin0_TYPE must be programmed to an input value for the Status_CLKin0 pin to function  
as an input for pin select mode.  
The Status_CLKin1_TYPE must be programmed to an input value for the Status_CLKin1 pin to function  
as an input for pin select mode.  
If the Status_CLKinX_TYPE is set as output, the input value is considered 0.  
The polarity of Status_CLKin1 and Status_CLKin0 input pins cannot be inverted with the CLKin_SEL_INV  
bit.  
Table 1 defines which input clock is active depending on Status_CLKin0 and Status_CLKin1 state.  
24  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Feature Description (continued)  
Table 1. Active Clock Input - Pin Select Mode  
STATUS_CLKin1  
STATUS_CLKin0  
ACTIVE CLOCK  
CLKin0  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
CLKin1  
Reserved  
Holdover  
The pin select mode will override the EN_CLKinX bits such that the CLKinX buffer will operate even if CLKinX is  
disabled with EN_CLKinX = 0. To switch as fast as possible, keep the clock input buffers enabled (EN_CLKinX =  
1) that could be switched to.  
8.3.4.2.1 Pin Select Mode and Host  
When in the pin select mode, the host can monitor conditions of the clocking system which could cause the host  
to switch the active clock input. The LMK0480x device can also provide indicators on the Status_LD and  
Status_HOLDOVER like "DAC Rail," "PLL1 DLD", "PLL1 and PLL2 DLD" which the host can use in determining  
which clock input to use as active clock input.  
8.3.4.2.2 Switch Event without Holdover  
When an input clock switch event is triggered and holdover mode is disabled, the active clock input immediately  
switches to the selected clock. When PLL1 is designed with a narrow loop bandwidth, the switching transient is  
minimized.  
8.3.4.2.3 Switch Event with Holdover  
When an input clock switch event is triggered and holdover mode is enabled, the device will enter holdover mode  
and remain in holdover until a holdover exit condition is met as described in Holdover Mode. Then the device will  
complete the reference switch to the pin selected clock input.  
8.3.4.3 Input Clock Switching - Automatic Mode  
When CLKin_SELECT_MODE is 4, the active clock is selected in priority order of enabled clock inputs starting  
upon an input clock switch event. The priority order of the clocks is CLKin0 CLKin1 CLKin0, and so forth.  
For a clock input to be eligible to be switched through, it must be enabled using EN_CLKinX.  
8.3.4.3.1 Starting Active Clock  
Upon programming this mode, the currently active clock remains active if PLL1 lock detect is high. To ensure a  
particular clock input is the active clock when starting this mode, program CLKin_SELECT_MODE to the manual  
mode which selects the desired clock input (CLKin0 or 1). Wait for PLL1 to lock PLL1_DLD = 1, then select this  
mode with CLKin_SELECT_MODE = 4.  
8.3.4.3.2 Clock Switch Event: PLL1 DLD  
A loss of lock as indicated by PLL1’s DLD signal (PLL1_DLD = 0) will cause an input clock switch event if  
DISABLE_DLD1_DET = 0. PLL1 DLD must go high (PLL1_DLD = 1) in between input clock switching events.  
8.3.4.3.3 Clock Switch Event: PLL1 Vtune Rail  
If Vtune_RAIL_DET_EN is set and the PLL1 Vtune voltage crosses the DAC high or low threshold, holdover  
mode will be entered. Since PLL1_DLD = 0 in holdover a clock input switching event will occur.  
8.3.4.3.4 Clock Switch Event with Holdover  
Clock switch event with holdover enabled is recommended in this input clock switching mode. When an input  
clock switch event occurs, holdover mode is entered and the active clock is set to the clock input defined by the  
Status_CLKinX pins. When the new active clock meets the holdover exit conditions, holdover is exited and the  
active clock will continue to be used as a reference until another input clock switch event. PLL1 DLD must go  
high in between input clock switching events.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
25  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.3.4.4 Input Clock Switching - Automatic Mode with Pin Select  
When CLKin_SELECT_MODE is 6, the active clock is selected using the Status_CLKinX pins upon an input  
clock switch event according to Table 2.  
8.3.4.4.1 Starting Active Clock  
Upon programming this mode, the currently active clock remains active if PLL1 lock detect is high. To ensure a  
particular clock input is the active clock when starting this mode, program CLKin_SELECT_MODE to the manual  
mode which selects the desired clock input (CLKin0 or 1). Wait for PLL1 to lock PLL1_DLD = 1, then select this  
mode with CLKin_SELECT_MODE = 6.  
8.3.4.4.2 Clock Switch Event: PLL1 DLD  
An input clock switch event is generated by a loss of lock as indicated by PLL1's DLD signal (PLL1 DLD = 0).  
8.3.4.4.3 Clock Switch Event: PLL1 Vtune Rail  
If Vtune_RAIL_DET_EN is set and the PLL1 Vtune voltage crosses the DAC threshold, holdover mode will be  
entered. Since PLL1_DLD = 0 in holdover, a clock input switching event will occur.  
8.3.4.4.4 Clock Switch Event with Holdover  
Clock switch event with holdover enabled is recommended in this input clock switching mode. When an input  
clock switch event occurs, holdover mode is entered and the active clock is set to the clock input defined by the  
Status_CLKinX pins. When the new active clock meets the holdover exit conditions, holdover is exited and the  
active clock will continue to be used as a reference until another input clock switch event. PLL1 DLD must go  
high in between input clock switching events."  
Table 2. Active Clock Input - Auto Pin Mode  
STATUS_CLKin1(1)  
STATUS_CLKin0  
ACTIVE CLOCK  
CLKin0  
X
1
0
1
0
0
CLKin1  
Reserved  
(1) The polarity of Status_CLKin1 and Status_CLKin0 input pins can be inverted with the CLKin_SEL_INV bit.  
8.3.5 Holdover Mode  
Holdover mode causes PLL2 to stay locked on frequency with minimal frequency drift when an input clock  
reference to PLL1 becomes invalid. While in holdover mode, the PLL1 charge pump is TRI-STATED and a fixed  
tuning voltage is set on CPout1 to operate PLL1 in open loop.  
8.3.5.1 Enable Holdover  
Program HOLDOVER_MODE to enable holdover mode. Holdover mode can be manually enabled by  
programming the FORCE_HOLDOVER bit.  
The holdover mode can be set to operate in 2 different sub-modes.  
Fixed CPout1 (EN_TRACK = 0 or 1, EN_MAN_DAC = 1).  
Tracked CPout1 (EN_TRACK = 1, EN_MAN_DAC = 0).  
Not valid when EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DET = 1.  
Updates to the DAC value for the Tracked CPout1 sub-mode occurs at the rate of the PLL1 phase detector  
frequency divided by DAC_CLK_DIV. These updates occur any time EN_TRACK = 1.  
The DAC update rate should be programmed for <= 100 kHz to ensure DAC holdover accuracy.  
When tracking is enabled the current voltage of DAC can be readback, see DAC_CNT.  
26  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.3.5.2 Entering Holdover  
The holdover mode is entered as described in Input Clock Switching. Typically this is because:  
FORCE_HOLDOVER bit is set.  
PLL1 loses lock according to PLL1_DLD, and  
HOLDOVER_MODE = 2  
DISABLE_DLD1_DET = 0  
CPout1 voltage crosses DAC high or low threshold, and  
HOLDOVER_MODE = 2  
EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DET = 1  
EN_TRACK = 1  
DAC_HIGH_TRIP = User Value  
DAC_LOW_TRIP = User Value  
EN_MAN_DAC = 1  
MAN_DAC = User Value  
8.3.5.3 During Holdover  
PLL1 is run in open loop mode.  
PLL1 charge pump is set to TRI-STATE.  
PLL1 DLD will be unasserted.  
The HOLDOVER status is asserted  
During holdover If PLL2 was locked prior to entry of holdover mode, PLL2 DLD will continue to be asserted.  
CPout1 voltage will be set to:  
a voltage set in the MAN_DAC register (fixed CPout1).  
a voltage determined to be the last valid CPout1 voltage (tracked CPout1).  
PLL1 DLD will attempt to lock with the active clock input.  
The HOLDOVER status signal can be monitored on the Status_HOLDOVER or Status_LD pin by programming  
the HOLDOVER_MUX or LD_MUX register to "Holdover Status."  
8.3.5.4 Exiting Holdover  
Holdover mode can be exited in one of two ways.  
Manually, by programming the device from the host.  
Automatically, By a clock operating within a specified ppm of the current PLL1 frequency on the active clock  
input. See Input Clock Switching for more detail on which clock input is active.  
To exit holdover by programming, set HOLDOVER_MODE = Disabled. HOLDOVER_MODE can then be re-  
enabled by programming HOLDOVER_MODE = Enabled. Care should be taken to ensure that the active clock  
upon exiting holdover is as expected, otherwise the CLKin_SELECT_MODE register may need to be re-  
programmed.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
27  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.3.5.5 Holdover Frequency Accuracy and DAC Performance  
When in holdover mode PLL1 will run in open loop and the DAC will set the CPout1 voltage. If Fixed CPout1  
mode is used, then the output of the DAC will be a voltage dependant upon the MAN_DAC register. If Tracked  
CPout1 mode is used, then the output of the DAC will be the voltage at the CPout1 pin before holdover mode  
was entered. When using Tracked mode and EN_MAN_DAC = 1, during holdover the DAC value is loaded with  
the programmed value in MAN_DAC, not the tracked value.  
When in Tracked CPout1 mode the DAC has a worst case tracking error of ±2 LSBs once PLL1 tuning voltage is  
acquired. The step size is approximately 3.2 mV, therefore the VCXO frequency error during holdover mode  
caused by the DAC tracking accuracy is ±6.4 mV × Kv, where Kv is the tuning sensitivity of the VCXO in use.  
Therefore the accuracy of the system when in holdover mode in ppm is:  
± 6.4 mV × Kv × 1e6  
VCXO Frequency  
Holdover accuracy (ppm) =  
(1)  
Example: consider a system with a 19.2-MHz clock input, a 153.6-MHz VCXO with a Kv of 17 kHz/V. The  
accuracy of the system in holdover in ppm is:  
±6.4mV ´ 17kHz / V ´ 1e6  
±0.71ppm =  
153.6 MHz  
(2)  
It is important to account for this frequency error when determining the allowable frequency error window to  
cause holdover mode to exit.  
8.3.5.6 Holdover Mode - Automatic Exit of Holdover  
The LMK0480x device can be programmed to automatically exit holdover mode when the accuracy of the  
frequency on the active clock input achieves a specified accuracy. The programmable variables include  
PLL1_WND_SIZE and DLD_HOLD_CNT.  
See Digital Lock Detect Frequency Accuracy to calculate the register values to cause holdover to automatically  
exit upon reference signal recovery to within a user specified ppm error of the holdover frequency.  
It is possible for the time to exit holdover to vary because the condition for automatic holdover exit is for the  
reference and feedback signals to have a time/phase error less than a programmable value. Because it is  
possible for two clock signals to be very close in frequency but not close in phase, it may take a long time for the  
phases of the clocks to align themselves within the allowable time/phase error before holdover exits.  
8.3.6 PLLs  
8.3.6.1 PLL1  
The maximum phase detector frequency (fPD1) of PLL1 is 40 MHz. Since a narrow loop bandwidth should be  
used for PLL1, the need to operate at high phase detector rate to lower the in-band phase noise becomes  
unnecessary. The maximum values for the PLL1 R and N dividers is 16,383. Charge pump current ranges from  
100 to 1600 µA. PLL1 N divider may be driven by OSCin port at the OSCout0_MUX output (default) or by  
internal or external feedback as selected by Feedback Mux in 0-delay mode.  
Low charge pump currents and phase detector frequencies aid design of low loop bandwidth loop filters with  
reasonably sized components to allow the VCXO or PLL2 to dominate phase noise inside of PLL2 loop  
bandwidth. High charge pump currents may be used by PLL1 when using VCXOs with leaky tuning voltage  
inputs to improve system performance.  
8.3.6.2 PLL2  
PLL2's maximum phase detector frequency (fPD2) is 155 MHz. Operating at highest possible phase detector rate  
will ensure low in-band phase noise for PLL2 which in turn produces lower total jitter. The in-band phase noise  
from the reference input and PLL is proportional to N2. The maximum value for the PLL2 R divider is 4,095. The  
maximum value for the PLL2 N divider is 262,143. The N2 Prescaler in the total N feedback path can be  
programmed for values 2 to 8 (all divides even and odd). Charge pump current ranges from 100 to 3200 µA.  
High charge pump currents help to widen the PLL2 loop bandwidth to optimize PLL2 performance.  
28  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.3.6.2.1 PLL2 Frequency Doubler  
The PLL2 reference input at the OSCin port may be routed through a frequency doubler before the PLL2 R  
Divider. The frequency doubler feature allows the phase comparison frequency to be increased when a relatively  
low frequency oscillator is driving the OSCin port. By doubling the PLL2 phase detector frequency, the in-band  
PLL2 noise is reduced by about 3 dB.  
When using the doubler, PLL2 R Divider may be used to reduce the phase detector frequency to the limit of the  
PLL2 maximum phase detector frequency.  
For applications in which the OSCin frequency and PLL2 phase detector frequency are equal, the best PLL2 in-  
band noise can be achieved when the doubler is enabled (EN_PLL2_REF_2X = 1) and the PLL2 R divide value  
is 2. Do not use doubler disabled (EN_PLL2_REF_2X = 0) and PLL2 R divide value of 1.  
8.3.6.3 Digital Lock Detect  
Both PLL1 and PLL2 support digital lock detect. Digital lock detect compares the phase between the reference  
path (R) and the feedback path (N) of the PLL. When the time error, which is phase error, between the two  
signals is less than a specified window size (ε) a lock detect count increments. When the lock detect count  
reaches a user specified value lock detect is asserted true. Once digital lock detect is true, a single phase  
comparison outside the specified window will cause digital lock detect to be asserted false. This is illustrated in  
Figure 10.  
The incremental lock detect count feature functions as a digital filter to ensure that lock detect isn't asserted for  
only a brief time when the phases of R and N are within the specified tolerance for only a brief time during initial  
phase lock.  
The digital lock detect signal can be monitored on the Status_LD or Status_Holdover pin. The pin may be  
programmed to output the status of lock detect for PLL1, PLL2, or both PLL1 and PLL2.  
See Digital Lock Detect Frequency Accuracy for more detailed information on programming the registers to  
achieve a specified frequency accuracy in ppm with lock detect.  
The digital lock detect feature can also be used with holdover to automatically exit holdover mode. See Holdover  
Mode for more info.  
NO  
NO  
PLLX  
Lock Detected = False  
Lock Count = 0  
YES  
YES  
Increment  
PLLX Lock Count  
PLLX  
Lock Detected = True  
PLLX Lock Count =  
PLLX_DLD_CNT  
START  
Phase Error < g  
Phase Error < g  
YES  
NO  
Figure 10. Digital Lock Detect Flowchart  
8.3.7 Status Pins  
The Status_LD, Status_HOLDOVER, Status_CLKin0, Status_CLKin1, and SYNC pins can be programmed to  
output a variety of signals for indicating various statuses like digital lock detect, holdover, several DAC indicators,  
and several PLL divider outputs.  
8.3.7.1 Logic Low  
This is a vary simple output. In combination with the output _MUX register, this output can be toggled between  
high and low. Useful to confirm MICROWIRE programming or as a general purpose IO.  
8.3.7.2 Digital Lock Detect  
PLL1 DLD, PLL2 DLD, and PLL1 + PLL2 are selectable on certain output pins. See Digital Lock Detect for more  
information.  
8.3.7.3 Holdover Status  
Indicates if the device is in Holdover mode. See HOLDOVER_MODE for more information.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
29  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.3.7.4 DAC  
Various flags for the DAC can be monitored including DAC Locked, DAC Rail, DAC Low, and DAC High.  
When the PLL1 tuning voltage crosses the low threshold, DAC Low is asserted. When PLL1 tuning voltage  
crosses the high threshold, DAC High is asserted. When either DAC Low or DAC High is asserted, DAC Rail will  
also be asserted.  
DAC Locked is asserted when EN_Track = 1 and DAC is closely tracking the PLL1 tuning voltage.  
8.3.7.5 PLL Divider Outputs  
The PLL divider outputs are useful for debugging failure to lock issues. It allows the user to measure the  
frequency the PLL inputs are receiving. The settings of PLL1_R, PLL1_N, PLL2_R, and PLL2_N output pulses at  
the phase detector rate. The settings of PLL1_R / 2, PLL1_N / 2, PLL2_R / 2, and PLL2_N / 2 output a 50% duty  
cycle waveform at half the phase detector rate.  
8.3.7.6 CLKinX_LOS  
The clock input loss of signal indicator is asserted when LOS is enabled (EN_LOS) and the clock no longer  
detects an input as defined by the time-out threshold, LOS_TIMEOUT.  
8.3.7.7 CLKinX Selected  
If this clock is the currently selected/active clock, this pin will be asserted.  
8.3.7.8 MICROWIRE Readback  
The readback data can be output on any pin programmable to readback mode. For more information on  
readback see Readback.  
8.3.8 VCO  
The integrated VCO uses a frequency calibration routine when register R30 is programmed to lock VCO to target  
frequency. Register R30 contains the PLL2_N register.  
During the frequency calibration the PLL2_N_CAL value is used instead of PLL2_N, this allows 0-delay modes to  
have a separate PLL2 N value for VCO frequency calibration and regular operation. See Register 29, Register  
30, and PLL Programming for more information.  
30  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.3.9 Clock Distribution  
8.3.9.1 Fixed Digital Delay  
This section discussing Fixed Digital delay and associated registers is fundamental to understanding digital delay  
and dynamic digital delay.  
Clock outputs may be delayed or advanced from one another by up to 517.5 clock distribution path periods. By  
programming a digital delay value from 4.5 to 522 clock distribution path periods, a relative clock output delay  
from 0 to 517.5 periods is achieved. The CLKoutX_Y_DDLY (5 to 522) and CLKoutX_Y_HS (-0.5 or 0) registers  
set the digital delay as shown in Table 3.  
Table 3. Possible Digital Delay Values  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY  
CLKoutX_Y_HS  
DIGITAL DELAY  
5
5
1
0
1
0
1
0
...  
0
1
0
1
0
4.5  
5
6
5.5  
6
6
7
6.5  
7
7
...  
...  
520  
521  
521  
522  
522  
520  
520.5  
521  
521.5  
522  
Note: Digital delay values only take effect during a SYNC event and if the NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bit is cleared  
for this clock group. See Clock Output Synchronization (SYNC) for more information.  
The resolution of digital delay is determined by the frequency of the clock distribution path. The clock distribution  
path is the output of Mode Mux1 (Functional Block Diagram). The best resolution of digital delay is achieved by  
bypassing the VCO divider.  
VCO_DIV  
Digital Delay Resolution  
(with VCO Divider)  
=
2 × VCO Frequency  
(3)  
Digital Delay Resolution  
(VCO Divider bypassed or external VCO)  
1
=
2 × VCO Frequency  
(4)  
The digital delay between clock outputs can be dynamically adjusted with no or minimum disruption of the output  
clocks. See Dynamically Programming Digital Delay for more information.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
31  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.3.9.2 Fixed Digital Delay - Example  
Given a VCO frequency of 2949.12 MHz and no VCO divider, by using digital delay the outputs can be adjusted  
in 1 / (2 * 2949.12 MHz) = ~169.54 ps steps.  
To achieve quadrature (90 degree shift) between the 122.88-MHz outputs on CLKout4 and CLKout6 from a VCO  
frequency of 2949.12 MHz and bypassing the VCO divider, consider the following:  
1. The frequency of 122.88 MHz has a period of ~8.14 ns.  
2. To delay 90 degrees of a 122.88-MHz clock period requires a ~2.03 ns delay.  
3. Given a digital delay step of ~169.54 ps, this requires a digital delay value of 12 steps (2.03 ns / 169.54 ps =  
12).  
4. Since the 12 steps are half period steps, CLKout6_7_DDLY is programmed 6 full periods beyond 5 for a total  
of 11.  
This result in the following programming:  
Clock output dividers to 24. CLKout4_5_DIV = 24 and CLKout6_7_DIV = 24.  
Set first clock digital delay value. CLKout4_5_DDLY = 5, CLKout4_5_HS = 0.  
Set second 90 degree shifted clock digital delay value. CLKout6_7_DDLY = 11, CLKout6_7_HS = 0.  
Table 4 shows some of the possible phase delays in degrees achievable in the above example.  
Table 4. Relative Phase Shift from CLKout4 and 5 to CLKout6 and 7(1)  
CLKout6_7_DDLY  
CLKout6_7_HS  
RELATIVE DIGITAL DELAY  
DEGREES of 122.88 MHz  
5
5
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
...  
-0.5  
0.0  
0.5  
1.0  
1.5  
2.0  
2.5  
3.0  
3.5  
4.0  
4.5  
5.0  
5.5  
6.0  
6.5  
7.0  
7.5  
8.0  
8.5  
...  
-7.5°  
0°  
6
7.5°  
6
15.0°  
22.5°  
30.0°  
37.5°  
45.0°  
52.5°  
60.0°  
67.5°  
75.0°  
82.5°  
90.0°  
97.5°  
105.0°  
112.5°  
120.0°  
127.5°  
...  
7
7
8
8
9
9
10  
10  
11  
11  
12  
12  
13  
13  
14  
...  
(1) CLKout4_5_DDLY = 5 and CLKout4_5_HS = 0  
Figure 12 illustrates clock outputs programmed with different digital delay values during a SYNC event.  
Refer to Dynamically Programming Digital Delay for more information on dynamically adjusting digital delay.  
32  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.3.9.3 Clock Output Synchronization (SYNC)  
The purpose of the SYNC function is to synchronize the clock outputs with a fixed and known phase relationship  
between each clock output selected for SYNC. SYNC can also be used to hold the outputs in a low or 0 state.  
The NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bits can be set to disable synchronization for a clock group.  
To enable SYNC, EN_SYNC must be set. See EN_SYNC, Enable Synchronization.  
The digital delay value set by CLKoutX_Y_DDLY takes effect only upon a SYNC event. The digital delay due to  
CLKoutX_Y_HS takes effect immediately upon programming. See Dynamically Programming Digital Delay for  
more information on dynamically changing digital delay.  
During a SYNC event, clock outputs driven by the VCO are not synchronized to clock outputs driven by OSCin.  
OSCout0 and OSCout1 are always driven by OSCin. CLKout6, 7, 8, or 9 may be driven by OSCin depending on  
the CLKoutX_Y_OSCin_Sel bit value. While SYNC is asserted, NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y operates normally for  
CLKout6, 7, 8, and 9 under all circumstances. SYNC operates normally for CLKout6, 7, 8, and 9 when driven by  
VCO.  
8.3.9.3.1 Effect of SYNC  
When SYNC is asserted, the outputs to be synchronized are held in a logic low state. When SYNC is  
unasserted, the clock outputs to be synchronized are activated and will transition to a high state simultaneously  
with one another except where different digital delay values have been programmed.  
Refer to Dynamically Programming Digital Delay for SYNC functionality when SYNC_QUAL = 1.  
Table 5. Steady State Clock Output Condition Given Specified Inputs  
SYNC_TYPE  
SYNC_POL  
_INV  
SYNC PIN  
CLOCK OUTPUT STATE  
0,1,2 (Input)  
0,1,2 (Input)  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
Active  
Low  
1
0
0,1,2 (Input)  
Low  
0,1,2 (Input)  
1
Active  
Active  
Low  
3, 4, 5, 6 (Output)  
3, 4, 5, 6 (Output)  
0 or 1  
0 or 1  
8.3.9.3.2 Methods of Generating SYNC  
There are five methods to generate a SYNC event:  
Manual:  
Asserting the SYNC pin according to the polarity set by SYNC_POL_INV.  
Toggling the SYNC_POL_INV bit though MICROWIRE will cause a SYNC to be asserted.  
Automatic:  
If PLL1_SYNC_DLD or PLL2_SYNC_DLD is set, the SYNC pin will be asserted while DLD (digital lock  
detect) is false for PLL1 or PLL2 respectively.  
Programming Register R30, which contains PLL2_N will generate a SYNC event when using the internal  
VCO.  
Programming Register R0 through R5 when SYNC_EN_AUTO = 1.  
Note: Due to the speed of the clock distribution path (as fast as ~325 ps period) and the slow slew rate of the  
SYNC, the exact VCO cycle at which the SYNC is asserted or unasserted by the SYNC is undefined. The timing  
diagrams show a sharp transition of the SYNC to clarify functionality.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
33  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.3.9.3.3 Avoiding Clock Output Interruption Due to Sync  
Any CLKout groups that have their NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bits set will be unaffected by the SYNC event. It is  
possible to perform a SYNC operation with the NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bits cleared, then set the  
NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bits so that the selected clocks will not be affected by a future SYNC. Future SYNC  
events will not effect these clocks but will still cause the newly synchronized clocks to be re-synchronized using  
the currently programmed digital delay values. When this happens, the phase relationship between the first  
group of synchronized clocks and the second group of synchronized clocks will be undefined unless the SYNC  
pulse is qualified by an output clock. See Dynamically Programming Digital Delay .  
8.3.9.3.4 SYNC Timing  
When discussing the timing of the SYNC function, one cycle refers to one period of the clock distribution path.  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY &  
CLKoutX_Y_HS  
6 cycles  
6 cycles  
Distribution  
Path  
SYNC  
(SYNC_POL  
_INV=1)  
CLKout0  
CLKout2  
CLKout4  
D
A
B
C
CLKout0_1_DIV = 1 (valid only for external VCO mode)  
CLKout2_3_DIV = 2  
CLKout4_5_DIV = 4  
The digital delay for all clock outputs is 5  
The digital delay half step for all clock outputs is 0  
SYNC_QUAL = 0 (No qualification)  
Figure 11. Clock Output Synchronization Using the SYNC Pin (Active Low)  
Refer to Figure 11 during this discussion on the timing of SYNC. SYNC must be asserted for greater than one  
clock cycle of the clock distribution path to latch the SYNC event. After SYNC is asserted, the SYNC event is  
latched on the rising edge of the distribution path clock, at time A. After this event has been latched, the outputs  
will not reflect the low state for 6 cycles, at time B. Due to the asynchronous nature of SYNC with respect to the  
output clocks, it is possible that a glitch pulse could be created when the clock output goes low from the SYNC  
event. This is shown by CLKout4 in Figure 11 and CLKout2 in Figure 12. See Relative Dynamic Digital Delay for  
more information on synchronizing relative to an output clock to eliminate or minimize this glitch pulse.  
After SYNC becomes unasserted the event is latched on the following rising edge of the distribution path clock,  
time C. The clock outputs will rise at time D, coincident with a rising distribution clock edge that occurs after 6  
cycles plus as many more cycles as programmed by the digital delay for that clock output. Therefore, the  
soonest a clock output will become high is 11 cycles after the SYNC unassertion event registration, time C, when  
the smallest digital delay value of 5 is set. If CLKoutX_Y_HS = 1 and CLKoutX_Y_DDLY = 5, then the clock  
output will rise 10.5 cycles after SYNC is unassertion event registration.  
34  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY & CLKoutX_Y_HS  
6 cycles  
Distribution  
Path  
4.5  
cycles  
2.5  
cycles  
6 cycles  
1 cycle  
SYNC  
(SYNC_POL  
_INV=1)  
CLKout0  
CLKout2  
CLKout4  
CLKout5  
C
D
E F  
A
B
CLKout0_1_DIV = 2, CLKout0_1_DDLY = 5  
CLKout2_3_DIV = 4, CLKout2_3_DDLY = 7  
CLKout4_5_DIV = 4, CLKout4_5_DDLY = 8  
CLKout0_1_HS = 1  
CLKout2_3_HS = 0  
CLKout4_5_HS = 0  
SYNC_QUAL = 0 (No qualification)  
Figure 12. Clock Output Synchronization using the SYNC Pin (Active Low)  
Figure 12 illustrates the timing with different digital delays programmed.  
Time A) SYNC assertion event is latched.  
Time B) SYNC unassertion latched.  
Time C) All outputs toggle and remain low. A glitch pulse can occur at this time as shown by CLKout2.  
Time D) After 6 + 4.5 = 10.5 cycles CLKout0 rises. This is the shortest time from SYNC unassertion  
registration to clock rising edge possible.  
Time E) After 6 + 7 = 13 cycles CLKout2 rises. CLKout2 and CLKout4, 5 are programmed for quadrature  
operation.  
Time F) After 6 + 8 = 14 cycles CLKout4 and 5 rise. Since CLKout4 and 5 are driven by the same clock  
divider and delay circuit, their timing is always the same.  
8.3.9.3.5 Dynamically Programming Digital Delay  
To use dynamic digital delay synchronization qualification set SYNC_QUAL = 1. This causes the SYNC pulse to  
be qualified by a clock output so that the SYNC event occurs after a specified time from a clock output transition.  
This allows the relative adjustment of clock output phase in real-time with no or minimum interruption of clock  
outputs. Hence the term "dynamic digital delay".  
Note that changing the phase of a clock output requires momentarily altering in the rate of change of the clock  
output phase and therefore by definition results in a frequency distortion of the signal.  
Without qualifying the SYNC with an output clock, the newly synchronized clocks would have a random and  
unknown digital delay (or phase) with respect to clock outputs not currently being synchronized.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
35  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.3.9.3.5.1 Absolute vs. Relative Dynamic Digital Delay  
The clock used for qualification of SYNC is selected with the feedback mux (FEEDBACK_MUX).  
If the clock selected by the feedback mux has its NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y = 1, then an absolute dynamic digital  
delay adjustment will be performed during a SYNC event and the digital delay of the feedback clock will not be  
adjusted.  
If the clock selected by the feedback mux has its NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y = 0, then a self-referenced or relative  
dynamic digital delay adjustment will be performed during a SYNC event and the digital delay of the feedback  
clock will be adjusted.  
Clocks with NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y = 1 always operate without interruption.  
8.3.9.3.5.2 Dynamic Digital Delay and 0-Delay Mode  
When using a 0-delay mode absolute dynamic digital delay is recommended. Using relative dynamic digital  
delay with a 0-delay mode may result in a momentary clock loss on the adjusted clock also being used for 0-  
delay feedback that may result in PLL1 DLD becoming low. This may result in HOLDOVER mode being activated  
depending upon device configuration.  
8.3.9.3.5.3 SYNC and Minimum Step Size  
The minimum step size adjustment for digital delay is half a clock distribution path cycle. This is achieved by  
using the CLKoutX_Y_HS bit. The CLKoutX_Y_HS bit change effect is immediate without the need for SYNC. To  
shift digital delay using CLKoutX_Y_DDLY a SYNC signal must be generated for the change to take effect.  
8.3.9.3.5.4 Programming Overview  
To dynamically adjust the digital delay with respect to an existing clock output the device should be programmed  
as follows:  
Set SYNC_QUAL = 1 for clock output qualification.  
Set CLKout4_5_PD = 0. Required for proper operation of SYNC_QUAL = 1.  
Set EN_FEEDBACK_MUX = 1 to enable the feedback buffer.  
Set FEEDBACK_MUX to the clock output that the newly synchronized clocks will be qualified by.  
Set NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y = 1 for the output clocks that will continue to operate during the SYNC event.  
There is no interruption of output on these clocks.  
If FEEDBACK_MUX selects a clock output with NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y = 1, then absolute dynamic  
digital delay is performed.  
If FEEDBACK_MUX selects a clock output with NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y = 0, then self-referenced or  
relative dynamic digital delay is performed.  
The SYNC_EN_AUTO bit may be set to cause a SYNC event to begin when register R0 to R5 is  
programmed. The auto SYNC feature is a convenience since does not require the application to manually  
assert SYNC by toggling the SYNC_POL_INV bit or the SYNC pin when changing digital delay. However,  
under the following condition a special programming sequence is required if SYNC_EN_AUTO = 1:  
The CLKoutX_Y_DDLY value being set in the programmed register is 13 or more.  
Under the following condition a SYNC_EN_AUTO must = 0:  
If the application requires a digital delay resolution of half a clock distribution path cycle in relative  
dynamic digital delay mode because the HS bit must be fixed per Table 6 for a qualifying clock.  
8.3.9.3.5.5 Internal Dynamic Digital Delay Timing  
To dynamically adjust digital delay a SYNC must occur. Once the SYNC is qualified by an output clock, 3 cycles  
later an internal one shot pulse will occur. The width of the one shot pulse is 3 cycles. This internal one shot  
pulse will cause the outputs to turn off and then back on with a fixed delay with respect to the falling edge of the  
qualification clock. This allows for dynamic adjustments of digital delay with respect to an output clock.  
The qualified SYNC timing is shown in Figure 13 for absolute dynamic digital delay and Figure 14 for relative  
dynamic digital delay.  
36  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.3.9.3.5.6 Other Timing Requirements  
When adjusting digital delay dynamically, the falling edge of the qualifying clock selected by the  
FEEDBACK_MUX must coincide with the falling edge of the clock distribution path. For this requirement to be  
met, program the CLKoutX_Y_HS value of the qualifying clock group according to Table 6.  
Table 6. Half Step Programming Requirement of Qualifying Clock During Sync Event  
DISTRIBUTION PATH FREQUENCY  
CLKoutX_Y_DIV VALUE  
CLKoutX_Y_HS  
Even  
Odd  
Must = 1 during SYNC event.  
Must = 0 during SYNC event.  
Must = 0 during SYNC event.  
Must = 1 during SYNC event.  
1.8 GHz  
Even  
Odd  
< 1.8 GHz  
8.3.9.3.5.7 Absolute Dynamic Digital Delay  
Absolute dynamic digital delay can be used to program a clock output to a specific phase offset from another  
clock output.  
Pros:  
Simple direct phase adjustment with respect to another clock output.  
CLKoutX_Y_HS will remain constant for qualifying clock.  
Can easily use auto sync feature (SYNC_EN_AUTO = 1) when digital delay adjustment requires half step  
digital delay requirements.  
Can be used with 0-delay mode.  
Cons:  
For some phase adjustments there may be a glitch pulse due to SYNC assertion.  
For example see CLKout4 in Figure 11 and CLKout2 in Figure 12.  
8.3.9.3.5.7.1 Absolute Dynamic Digital Delay - Example  
To illustrate the absolute dynamic digital delay adjust procedure, consider the following example.  
System Requirements:  
VCO Frequency = 2949.12 MHz  
CLKout0 = 983.04 MHz (CLKout0_1_DIV = 3)  
CLKout2 = 491.52 MHz (CLKout2_3_DIV = 6)  
CLKout4 = 245.76 MHz (CLKout4_5_DIV = 12)  
For all clock outputs during initial programming:  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY = 5  
CLKoutX_Y_HS = 1  
NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y = 0  
The application requires the 491.52 MHz clock to be stepped in 30 degree steps (~169.5 ps), which is the  
minimum step resolution allowable by the clock distribution path requiring use of the half step bit  
(CLKoutX_Y_HS). That is 1 / 2949.52 MHz / 2 = ~169.5 ps. During the stepping of the 491.52-MHz clock, the  
983.04-MHz and 245.76-MHz clock must not be interrupted.  
Step 1: The device is programmed from register R0 to R30 with values that result in the device being locked and  
operating as desired, see the system requirements above. The phase of all the output clocks are aligned  
because all the digital delay and half step values were the same when the SYNC was generated by  
programming register R30. The timing of this is as shown in Figure 11.  
Step 2: Now the registers will be programmed to prepare for changing digital delay (or phase) dynamically.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
37  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Table 7. Register Setup for Absolute Dynamic Digital Delay Example  
REGISTER  
PURPOSE  
Use a clock output for qualifying the SYNC pulse for dynamically  
adjusting digital delay.  
SYNC_QUAL = 1  
EN_SYNC = 1 (default)  
CLKout4_5_PD = 0  
Required for SYNC functionality.  
Required when SYNC_QUAL = 1.  
CLKout4 and/or CLKout5 outputs may be powered down or in use.  
Enable the feedback mux for SYNC operation for dynamically  
adjusting digital delay.  
EN_FEEDBACK_MUX = 1  
FEEDBACK_MUX = 2 (CLKout4)  
NO_SYNC_CLKout0_1 = 1  
Use the fixed 245.76-MHz clock as the SYNC qualification clock.  
This clock output (983.04 MHz) won't be affected by SYNC. It will  
always operate without interruption.  
This clock output (245.76 MHz) won't be affected by SYNC. It will  
always operate without interruption.  
NO_SYNC_CLKout4_5 = 1  
This clock will also be the qualifying clock in this example.  
Since CLKout4 is the qualifying clock and CLKoutX_Y_DIV is even,  
the half step bit must be set to 1. See Table 6.  
CLKout4_5_HS = 1  
SYNC_EN_AUTO = 1  
Automatic generation of SYNC is allowed for this case.  
After the registers in Table 7 have been programmed, the application may now dynamically adjust the digital  
delay of CLKout2 (491.52 MHz).  
Step 3: Adjust digital delay of CLKout2.  
Refer to Table 8 for the programming values to set a specified phase offset from the absolute reference clock.  
Table 8 is dependant upon the qualifying clock divide value of 12, refer to Calculating Dynamic Digital Delay  
Values for any Divide for information on creating tables for any divide value.  
Table 8. Programming for Absolute Digital Delay Adjustment  
DEGREES OF ADJUSTMENT FROM INITIAL 491.52 MHz PHASE  
PROGRAMMING  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 7; CLKout2_3_HS = 1  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 7; CLKout2_3_HS = 0  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 8; CLKout2_3_HS = 1  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 8; CLKout2_3_HS = 0  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 9; CLKout2_3_HS = 1  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 9; CLKout2_3_HS = 0  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 10; CLKout2_3_HS = 1  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 10; CLKout2_3_HS = 0  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 5; CLKout2_3_HS = 1  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 5; CLKout2_3_HS = 0  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 6; CLKout2_3_HS = 1  
CLKout2_3_DDLY = 6; CLKout2_3_HS = 0  
+/-0 or +/-360 degrees  
30 degrees  
60 degrees  
90 degrees  
120 degrees  
150 degrees  
180 degrees  
210 degrees  
240 degrees  
270 degrees  
300 degrees  
330 degrees  
-330 degrees  
-300 degrees  
-270 degrees  
-240 degrees  
-210 degrees  
-180 degrees  
-150 degrees  
-120 degrees  
-90 degrees  
-60 degrees  
-30 degrees  
After setting the new digital delay values, the act of programming R1 will start a SYNC automatically because  
SYNC_EN_AUTO = 1.  
If the user elects to reduce the number of SYNCs because they are not required when only CLKout2_3_HS is  
set, then SYNC_EN_AUTO is = 0 and the SYNC may now be generated by toggling the SYNC pin or by toggling  
the SYNC_POL_INV bit. Because of the internal one shot pulse, no strict timing of the SYNC pin or  
SYNC_POL_INV bit is required.  
38  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
After the SYNC event, the clock output will adjust according to Table 8. See Figure 13 for a detailed view of the  
timing diagram. The timing diagram critical points are:  
Time A) SYNC assertion event is latched.  
Time B) First qualifying falling clock output edge.  
Time C) Second qualifying falling clock output edge.  
Time D) Internal one shot pulse begins. 5 cycles later clock outputs will be forced low  
Time E) Internal one shot pulse ends. 5 cycles + digital delay cycles later the synced clock outputs rise.  
Time F) Clock outputs are forced low. (CLKout2 is already low).  
Time G) Beginning of digital delay cycles.  
Time H) For CLKout2_3_DDLY = 6; the clock output rises now.  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY and  
CLKoutX_Y_HS  
5 cycles  
Distribution  
Path  
3 cycles 3 cycles  
5.5 cycles  
5.5 cycles  
SYNC  
Internal One  
Shot Pulse  
CLKout0 /6  
HS = 1  
CLKout2 /6  
HS = 1  
CLKout4 /12  
HS = 1  
1
2
AB  
C
D
E
F
G
H
Figure 13. Absolute Dynamic Digital Delay Programming Example  
(SYNC_QUAL = 1, Qualify with Clock Output)  
8.3.9.3.5.8 Relative Dynamic Digital Delay  
Relative dynamic digital delay can be used to program a clock output to a specific phase offset from another  
clock output.  
Pros:  
Simple direct phase adjustment with respect to same clock output.  
The clock output will always behave the same during digital delay adjustment transient. For some divide  
values there will be no glitch pulse.  
Cons:  
For some clock divide values there may be a glitch pulse due to SYNC assertion.  
Adjustments of digital delay requiring the half step bit (CLKoutX_Y_HS) for finer digital delay adjust is  
complicated.  
Use with 0-delay mode may result in PLL1 DLD becoming low and HOLDOVER mode becoming activated.  
DISABLE_DLD1_DET can be set to prevent HOLDOVER from becoming activated due to PLL1 DLD  
becoming low.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
39  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.3.9.3.5.8.1 Relative Dynamic Digital Delay - Example  
To illustrate the relative dynamic digital delay adjust procedure, consider the following example.  
System Requirements:  
VCO Frequency = 2949.12 MHz  
CLKout0 = 983.04 MHz (CLKout0_1_DIV = 3)  
CLKout2 = 491.52 MHz (CLKout2_3_DIV = 6)  
CLKout4 = 491.52 MHz (CLKout4_5_DIV = 6)  
For all clock outputs during initial programming:  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY = 5  
CLKoutX_Y_HS = 0  
NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y = 0  
The application requires the 491.52-MHz clock to be stepped in 30 degree steps (~169.5 ps), which is the  
minimum step resolution allowable by the clock distribution path. That is 1 / 2949.52 MHz / 2 = ~169.5 ps. During  
the stepping of the 491.52 MHz clocks the 983.04 MHz clock must not be interrupted.  
Step 1: The device is programmed from register R0 to R30 with values that result in the device being locked and  
operating as desired, see the system requirements above. The phase of all the output clocks are aligned  
because all the digital delay and half step values were the same when the SYNC was generated by  
programming register R30. The timing of this is as shown in Figure 11.  
Step 2: Now the registers will be programmed to prepare for changing digital delay (or phase) dynamically.  
Table 9. Register Setup for Relative Dynamic Digital Delay Adjustment  
REGISTER  
SYNC_QUAL = 1  
PURPOSE  
Use clock output for qualifying the SYNC pulse for dynamically adjusting digital delay.  
Required for SYNC functionality.  
EN_SYNC = 1 (default)  
Required when SYNC_QUAL = 1.  
CLKout4 and/or CLKout5 outputs may be powered down or in use.  
CLKout4_5_PD = 0  
EN_FEEDBACK_MUX = 1  
Enable the feedback mux for SYNC operation for dynamically adjusting digital delay.  
Use the clock itself as the SYNC qualification clock.  
FEEDBACK_MUX = 1 (CLKout2)  
This clock output (983.04 MHz) won't be affected by SYNC. It will always operate without  
interruption.  
NO_SYNC_CLKout0_1 = 1  
NO_SYNC_CLKout4_5 = 1  
CLKout3’s phase is not to change with respect to CLKout0.  
Automatic generation of SYNC is not allowed because of the half step requirement in relative  
dynamic digital delay mode.  
SYNC_EN_AUTO = 0 (default)  
SYNC must be generated manually by toggling the SYNC_POL_INV bit or the SYNC pin.  
After the above registers have been programmed, the application may now dynamically adjust the digital delay of  
the 491.52 MHz clocks.  
Step 3: Adjust digital delay of CLKout2 by one step which is 30 degrees or ~169.5 ps.  
Refer to Table 10 for the programming sequence to step one half clock distribution period forward or backwards.  
Refer to Calculating Dynamic Digital Delay Values for any Divide for more information on how to calculate digital  
delay and half step values for other cases.  
To fulfill the qualifying clock output half step requirement in Table 6 when dynamically adjusting digital delay, the  
CLKoutX_Y_HS bit must be cleared for clocks with even divides. So before any dynamic digital delay  
adjustment, CLKoutX_Y_HS must be clear because the clock divide value is even. To achieve the final required  
digital delay adjustment, the CLKoutX_Y_HS bit may set after SYNC.  
40  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Table 10. Programming Sequence for One Step Adjust  
STEP DIRECTION and CURRENT HS STATE  
PROGRAMMING SEQUENCE  
1. CLKout2_3_HS = 1.  
Adjust clock output one step forward.  
CLKout2_3_HS is 0.  
1. CLKout2_3_DDLY = 9.  
2. Perform SYNC event.  
3. CLKout2_3_HS = 0.  
Adjust clock output one step forward.  
CLKout2_3_HS is 1.  
1. CLKout2_3_HS = 1.  
2. CLKout2_3_DDLY = 5.  
3. Perform SYNC event.  
Adjust clock output one step backward.  
CLKout2_3_HS is 0.  
Adjust clock output one step backward.  
CLKout2_3_HS is 1.  
1. CLKout2_3_HS = 0.  
After programing the updated CLKout2_3_DDLY and CLKout2_3_HS values, perform a SYNC event. The SYNC  
may be generated by toggling the SYNC pin or by toggling the SYNC_POL_INV bit. Because of the internal one  
shot pulse, no strict timing of the SYNC pin or SYNC_POL_INV bit is required. After the SYNC event, the clock  
output will be at the specified phase. See Figure 14 for a detailed view of the timing diagram. The timing diagram  
critical points are:  
Time A) SYNC assertion event is latched.  
Time B) First qualifying falling clock output edge.  
Time C) Second qualifying falling clock output edge.  
Time D) Internal one shot pulse begins. 5 cycles later clock outputs will be forced low.  
Time E) Internal one shot pulse ends. 5 cycles + digital delay cycles later the synced clock outputs rise.  
Time F) Clock outputs are forced low. (CLKouts are already low).  
Time G) Beginning of digital delay cycles.  
Time H) For CLKout2_3_DDLY = 9; the clock output rises now.  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY  
and CLKoutX_Y_HS  
5 cycles  
Distribution  
Path  
3 cycles 3 cycles  
5.5 cycles  
8.5 cycles  
SYNC  
Internal One  
Shot Pulse  
CLKout0 /3  
HS = 1  
CLKout2 /6  
HS = 1  
1
2
CLKout4 /6  
HS = 1  
AB  
C
D
E
F
G
H
(SYNC_QUAL = 1, Qualify with clock output)  
Starting condition is after half step is removed (CLKout2_3_HS = 0).  
Figure 14. Relative Dynamic Digital Delay Programming Example, 2nd Adjust  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
41  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.3.10 0-Delay Mode  
When 0-delay mode is enabled the clock output selected by the Feedback Mux is connected to the PLL1 N  
counter to ensure a fixed phase relationship between the selected CLKin and the fed back CLKout. When all the  
clock outputs are synced together, all the clock outputs will share the same fixed phase relationship between the  
selected CLKin and the fed back CLKout. The feedback can be internal or external using FBCLKin port.  
When 0-delay mode is enabled the lowest frequency clock output is fed back to the Feedback Mux to ensure a  
repeatable fixed CLKin to CLKout phase relationship between all clock outputs.  
If a clock output that is not the lowest frequency output is selected for feedback, then clocks with lower  
frequencies will have an unknown phase relationship with respect the other clocks and clock input. There will be  
a number of possible phase relationships equal to Feedback_Clock_Frequency / Lower_Clock_Frequency that  
may occur.  
The Feedback Mux selects the even clock output of any clock group for internal feedback or the FBCLKin port for  
external 0-delay feedback. The even clock can remain powered down as long as the CLKoutX_Y_PD bit is = 0  
for its clock group.  
To use 0-delay mode, the bit EN_FEEDBACK_MUX must be set (=1) to power up the feedback mux.  
See PLL Programming for more information on programming PLL1_N for 0-delay mode.  
When using an external VCO mode, internal 0-delay feedback must be used since the FBCLKin port is shared  
with the Fin input.  
Table 11 outlines several registers to program for 0-delay mode.  
Table 11. Programming 0-Delay Mode  
REGISTER  
MODE = 2 or 15  
PURPOSE  
Select one of the 0-delay modes for device.  
Enable feedback mux.  
EN_FEEDBACK_MUX = 1  
FEEDBACK_MUX = Application Specific  
Select CLKout or FBCLKin for 0-delay feedback.  
The divide value of the clock selected by FEEDBACK_MUX is  
important for PLL2 N value calculation  
CLKoutX_Y_DIV  
PLL1_N  
PLL1_N value used with CLKoutX_Y_DIV in loop.  
42  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.4 Device Functional Modes  
8.4.1 Mode Selection  
The LMK0480x family is capable of operating in several different modes as programmed by MODE: Device  
Mode.  
Table 12. Device Mode Selection  
MODE  
R11[31:27]  
PLL1  
PLL2  
PLL2 VCO  
0-DELAY  
CLOCK DIST  
0
2
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Internal  
Internal  
External  
Internal  
Internal  
External  
External  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
3
6
8
X
X
11  
15  
16(1)  
X
(1) See Mode 15 Additional Configurations  
In addition to selecting the device's mode of operation above, some modes require additional configuration. Also  
there are other features including holdover and dynamic digital delay that can also be enabled.  
Table 13. Registers to Further Configure Device Mode of Operation  
DYNAMIC DIGITAL  
REGISTER  
HOLDOVER  
0-DELAY  
DELAY  
HOLDOVER_MODE  
EN_TRACK  
2
User  
User  
User  
User  
DAC_CLK_DIV  
EN_MAN_DAC  
DISABLE_DLD1_DET  
EN_VTUNE_RAIL_  
DET  
User  
DAC_HIGH_TRIP  
DAC_LOW_TRIP  
FORCE_HOLDOVER  
SYNC_EN_AUTO  
SYNC_QUAL  
User  
User  
0
User  
1
EN_SYNC  
1
CLKout4_5_PD  
0
EN_  
1
Feedback Clock  
1
FEEDBACK_MUX  
FEEDBACK_MUX  
Qualifying Clock  
User  
NO_SYNC_  
CLKoutX_Y  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
43  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.4.2 Operating Modes  
The LMK0480x is a flexible device that can be configured for many different use cases. The following simplified  
block diagrams help show the user the different use cases of the device.  
8.4.2.1 Dual PLL  
Figure 15 illustrates the typical use case of the LMK0480x in dual loop mode. In dual loop mode the reference to  
PLL1 is either CLKin0 or CLKin1. An external VCXO or tunable crystal will be used to provide feedback for the  
first PLL and a reference to the second PLL. This first PLL cleans the jitter with the VCXO or low cost tunable  
crystal by using a narrow loop bandwidth. The VCXO or tunable crystal output may be buffered through the two  
OSCout ports and optionally on up to 4 of the CLKouts. The VCXO or tunable crystal is used as the reference to  
PLL2 and may be doubled using the frequency doubler. The internal VCO drives up to six divide/delay blocks  
which drive 12 clock outputs.  
Holdover functionality is optionally available when the input reference clock is lost. Holdover works by fixing the  
tuning voltage of PLL1 to the VCXO or tunable crystal.  
It is also possible to use an external VCO in place of PLL2's internal VCO.  
PLL1  
PLL2  
External  
Loop Filter  
OSCoutX  
External VCXO  
or Tunable  
Crystal  
OSCoutX*  
2 outputs  
CLKinX  
CLKinX*  
R
N
Phase  
Detector  
PLL1  
CPout2  
External  
Loop Filter  
2 inputs  
CLKoutY  
CLKoutY*  
R
N
Phase  
Detector  
PLL2  
Divider  
Digital Delay  
Analog Delay  
Partially  
Integrated  
Loop Filter  
Input  
Buffer  
CLKoutX  
CLKoutX*  
Internal  
VCO  
12 outputs  
6 blocks  
LMK0480x  
Figure 15. Simplified Functional Block Diagram for Dual Loop Mode  
8.4.2.2 0-Delay Dual PLL  
Figure 16 illustrates the use case of 0-delay dual loop mode. This configuration is very similar to Dual PLL except  
that the feedback to the first PLL is driven by a clock output. This causes the clock outputs to have deterministic  
phase with respect to the clock input. Since all the clock outputs can be synchronized together, all the clock  
outputs can be in phase with the clock input signal. The feedback to PLL1 can be connected internally as shown,  
or externally using FBCLKin (CLKin1) as an input port.  
It is also possible to use an external VCO in place of PLL2's internal VCO.  
PLL1  
PLL2  
External  
Loop Filter  
OSCoutX  
External VCXO  
or Tunable  
Crystal  
OSCoutX*  
2 outputs  
CLKinX  
CLKinX*  
R
N
Phase  
Detector  
PLL1  
CPout2  
External  
Loop Filter  
2 inputs  
CLKoutY  
CLKoutY*  
R
N
Phase  
Detector  
PLL2  
Divider  
Digital Delay  
Analog Delay  
Partially  
Integrated  
Loop Filter  
Input  
Buffer  
CLKoutX  
CLKoutX*  
Internal  
VCO  
12 outputs  
6 blocks  
Internal or external loopback, user programmable  
LMK0480x  
Figure 16. Simplified Functional Block Diagram for 0-delay Dual Loop Mode  
44  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.4.2.3 Single PLL  
Figure 17 illustrates the use case of single PLL mode. In single PLL mode only PLL2 is used and PLL1 is  
powered down. OSCin is used as the reference input. The internal VCO drives up to 6 divide/delay blocks which  
drive 12 clock outputs. The reference at OSCin can be used to drive up to 2 OSCout ports. OSCin can also  
optionally drive up to 4 of the clock outputs.  
It is also possible to use an external VCO in place of PLL2's internal VCO.  
PLL2  
External  
Loop Filter  
OSCoutX  
OSCoutX*  
2 outputs  
CPout2  
OSCin  
OSCin*  
CLKoutY  
CLKoutY*  
R
N
Phase  
Detector  
PLL2  
Divider  
Digital Delay  
Analog Delay  
Partially  
Integrated  
Loop Filter  
CLKoutX  
CLKoutX*  
Internal  
VCO  
12 outputs  
6 blocks  
LMK0480x  
Figure 17. Simplified Functional Block Diagram for Single Loop Mode  
8.4.2.4 0-Delay Single PLL  
Figure 18 illustrates the use case of 0-delay single PLL mode. This configuration is very similar to Single PLL  
except that the feedback to PLL2 comes from a clock output. This causes the clock outputs to be in phase with  
the reference input. Since all the clock outputs can be synchronized together, all the clock outputs can be in  
phase with the clock input signal. The feedback to PLL2 can be performed internally as shown, or externally  
using FBCLKin (CLKin1) as an input port.  
It is also possible to use an external VCO in place of PLL2's internal VCO.  
PLL2  
External  
Loop Filter  
OSCoutX  
OSCoutX*  
2 outputs  
CPout2  
OSCin  
OSCin*  
CLKoutY  
CLKoutY*  
R
N
Phase  
Detector  
PLL2  
Divider  
Digital Delay  
Analog Delay  
Partially  
Integrated  
Loop Filter  
CLKoutX  
CLKoutX*  
12 outputs  
Internal  
VCO  
6 blocks  
Internal or external loopback, user programmable  
LMK0480x  
Figure 18. Simplified Functional Block Diagram for 0-delay Single Loop Mode  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
45  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.4.2.5 Clock Distribution  
Figure 19 illustrates the LMK0480x used for clock distribution. CLKin1 is used to drive up to 6 divide/delay blocks  
which drive 12 outputs. OSCin can be used to drive up to 2 OSCout ports. OSCin can also optionally drive up to  
4 of the clock outputs.  
CLKoutY  
Divider  
Digital Delay  
Analog Delay  
CLKoutY*  
CLKin1  
CLKin1*  
CLKoutX  
CLKoutX*  
12 outputs  
6 blocks  
OSCoutX  
OSCoutX*  
2 outputs  
OSCin  
OSCin*  
LMK0480x  
Figure 19. Simplified Functional Block Diagram for Mode Clock Distribution  
8.4.2.6 Mode 15 Additional Configurations  
Special considerations must be made when configuring the LMK0480x device in Dual PLL, 0-delay, External  
VCO mode (Mode 15). These additional registers can be programmed in sequential order as recommended or  
before R11 to ensure OSCoutX operation state is as desired when MODE register is programmed to 15 (0x0F).  
Program register R20 to 0x0784 E854 (This results in OSCout0 and 1 powered off. Program as desired).  
Program register R22 to 0x0000 0456  
Additionally, OSCoutX power down functions are relocated to different register locations. Table 14 describes the  
reconfiguration of these control bits.  
Table 14. Mode 15 Reconfiguration of Control Bits  
DUAL PLL, 0-DELAY, EXTERNAL VCO, MODE 15  
PD_OSCout0 R20[23]  
ALL OTHER MODES  
EN_OSCout0 R10[22]  
OSCout0  
OSCout1  
0 = OSCout0 is enabled (POR Default)  
1 = OSCout0 is disabled  
0 = OSCout0 is disabled  
1 = OSCout0 is enabled (POR Default)  
EN_OSCout1 R10[23]  
PD_OSCout1 R20[24]  
0 = OSCout1 is enabled (POR Default)  
1 = OSCout1 is disabled  
0 = OSCout1 is disabled (POR Default)  
1 = OSCout1 is enabled  
46  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.5 Programming  
LMK0480x devices are programmed using 32-bit registers. Each register consists of a 5-bit address field and 27-  
bit data field. The address field is formed by bits 0 through 4 (LSBs) and the data field is formed by bits 5 through  
31 (MSBs). The contents of each register is clocked in MSB first (bit 31), and the LSB (bit 0) last. During  
programming, the LEuWire signal should be held low. The serial data is clocked in on the rising edge of the  
CLKuWire signal. After the LSB (bit 0) is clocked in the LEuWire signal should be toggled low-to-high-to-low to  
latch the contents into the register selected in the address field. It is recommended to program registers in  
numeric order, for example R0 to R16, and R24 to R31 to achieve proper device operation. Figure 6 illustrates  
the serial data timing sequence.  
To achieve proper frequency calibration, the OSCin port must be driven with a valid signal before programming  
register R30. Changes to PLL2 R divider or the OSCin port frequency require register R30 to be reloaded in  
order to activate the frequency calibration process.  
8.5.1 Special Programming Case for R0 to R5 for CLKoutX_Y_DIV and CLKoutX_Y_DDLY  
In some cases when programming register R0 to R5 to change the CLKoutX_Y_DIV divide value or  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY delay value, 3 additional CLKuWire cycles must occur after loading the register for the newly  
programmed divide or delay value to take effect. These special cases include:  
When CLKoutX_Y_DIV is > 25.  
When CLKoutX_Y_DDLY is > 12. Note: loading the digital delay value only prepares for a future SYNC  
event.  
Also, since SYNC_EN_AUTO bit = 1 automatically generates a SYNC on the falling edge of LE when R0 to R5 is  
programmed, further programming considerations must be made when SYNC_EN_AUTO = 1.  
These special programming cases requiring the additional three clock cycles may be properly programmed by  
one of the following methods shown in Table 15.  
Table 15. R0 to R5 Special Case  
SYNC  
_EN_  
AUTO  
CLKoutX_Y_DIV and  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY  
PROGRAMMING METHOD  
CLKoutX_Y_DIV 25 and  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY 12  
0 or 1  
No Additional Clocks Required (Normal)  
CLKoutX_Y_DIV > 25 or  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY > 12  
Three Extra CLKuWire Clocks (Or program another  
register)  
0
1
CLKoutX_Y_DIV > 25 or  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY > 12  
Three Extra CLKuWire Clocks while LEuWire is  
High  
Method: No Additional Clocks Required (Normal) No special consideration to CLKuWire is required when  
changing divide value to 25, digital delay value to 12, or when the digital delay and divide value do not  
change. See MICROWIRE timing Figure 6.  
Method: Three Extra CLKuWire Clocks Three extra clocks must be provided before CLKoutX_Y_DIV > 25  
or CLKoutX_Y_DDLY > 12 take effect. See MICROWIRE timing Figure 7. Also, by programming another  
register the three clock requirement can be satisfied.  
Method: Three Extra CLKuWire Clocks with LEuWire Asserted When SYNC_EN_AUTO = 1 the falling  
edge of LEuWire will generate a SYNC event. CLKoutX_Y_DIV and CLKoutX_Y_DDLY values must be  
updated before the SYNC event occurs. So 3 CLKuWire rising edges must occur before LEuWire goes low.  
See MICROWIRE timing Figure 8.  
Initial Programming Sequence During the recommended programming sequence the device is programmed  
in order from R0 to R31, so it is expected at least one additional register will be programmed after  
programming the last CLKoutX_Y_DIV or CLKoutX_Y_DDLY value in R0 to R5. This will result in the extra  
needed CLKuWire rising edges, so this special note is of little concern. If programming R0 to R5 to change  
CLKout frequency or digital delay or dynamic digital delay at a later time in the application, take care to  
provide these extra CLKuWire cycles to properly load the new divide and/or delay values.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
47  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.5.1.1 Example  
In this example, all registers have been programmed, the PLLs are locked. An LMK04808 has been generating a  
clock output frequency of 61.44 MHz on CLKout4 using a VCO frequency of 2949.12 MHz and a divide value of  
48. SYNC_EN_AUTO = 0. At a later time the application requires a 30.72-MHz output on CLKout4. By  
reprogramming register R4 with CLKout4_5_DIV = 96 twice, the divide value of 96 is set for clock outputs 4 and  
5 which results in an output frequency of 30.72 MHz (2949.12 MHz / 96 = 30.72 MHz) on CLKout4.  
In this example the required 3 CLKuWire cycles were achieved by reprogramming the R4 register with the same  
value twice.  
8.5.2 Recommended Programming Sequence  
Registers are programmed in numeric order with R0 being the first and R31 being the last register programmed.  
The recommended programming sequence involves programming R0 with the reset bit (b17) set to 1 to ensure  
the device is in a default state. If R0 is programmed again, the reset bit must be cleared to 0 during the  
programming of R0.  
8.5.2.1 Overview  
Program R0 with RESET bit = 1. This ensures that the device is configured with default settings. When  
RESET = 1, all other R0 bits are ignored.  
If R0 is programmed again during the initial configuration of the device, the RESET bit must be cleared.  
R0 through R5: CLKouts.  
Program as necessary to configure the clock outputs, CLKout0 to CLKout11 as desired. These registers  
configure clock output controls such as powerdown, digital delay and divider value, analog delay select,  
and clock source select.  
R6 through R8: CLKouts.  
Program as necessary to configure the clock outputs, CLKout0 to CLKout11 as desired. These registers  
configure the output format for each clock outputs and the analog delay for the clock output groups.  
R9: Required programming  
Program this register as shown in the register map for proper operation.  
R10: OSCouts, VCO divider, and 0-delay.  
Enable and configure clock outputs OSCout0/1.  
Set and select VCO divider (VCO bypass is recommended).  
Set 0-delay feedback source if used.  
R11: Part mode, SYNC, and XTAL.  
Program to configure the mode of the part, to configure SYNC functionality and pin, and to enable crystal  
mode.  
R12: Pins, SYNC, and holdover mode.  
Status_LD pin, more SYNC options to generate a SYNC upon PLL1 and/or PLL2 lock detect.  
Enable clock features such as holdover.  
R13: Pins, holdover mode, and CLKins.  
Status_HOLDOVER, Status_CLKin0, and Status_CLKin1 pin controls.  
Enable clock inputs for use in specific part modes.  
R14: Pins, LOS, CLKins, and DAC.  
Status_CLKin1 pin control.  
Loss of signal detection, CLKin type, DAC rail detect enable and high and low trip points.  
R15: DAC and holdover mode.  
Program to enable and set the manual DAC value.  
HOLDOVER mode options.  
R16: Crystal amplitude.  
Increasing XTAL_LVL can improve tunable crystal phase noise performance.  
R24: PLL1 and PLL2.  
PLL1 N and R delay and PLL1 digital lock delay value.  
48  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
PLL2 integrated loop filter.  
R25: DAC and PLL1.  
Program to configure DAC update clock divider and PLL1 digital lock detect count.  
R26: PLL2.  
Program to configure PLL2 options.  
R27: CLKins and PLL1.  
Clock input pre-dividers.  
Program to configure PLL1 options.  
R28: PLL1 and PLL2.  
Program to configure PLL2 R and PLL1 N.  
R29: OSCin and PLL2.  
Program to configure oscillator input frequency, PLL2 fast phase detector frequency mode, and PLL2 N  
calibration value.  
R30: PLL2.  
Program to configure PLL2 prescaler and PLL2 N value.  
R31: uWire lock.  
Program to set the uWire_LOCK bit.  
8.5.3 Readback  
At no time should the MICROWIRE registers be programmed to any value other than what is specified in the  
datasheet.  
For debug of the MICROWIRE interface, it is recommended to simply program an output pin mux to active low  
and then toggle the output type register between output and inverting output while observing the output pin for a  
low to high transition. For example, to verify MICROWIRE programming, set the LD_MUX = 0 (Low) and then  
toggle the LD_TYPE register between 3 (Output, push-pull) and 4 (Output inverted, push-pull). The result will be  
that the Status_LD pin will toggle from low to high.  
Readback from the MICROWIRE programming registers is available. The MICROWIRE readback function can  
be enabled on the Status_LD, Status_HOLDOVER, Status_CLKin0, Status_CLKin1, or SYNC pin by  
programming the corresponding MUX register to “uWire Readback” and the corresponding TYPE register to  
"Output (push-pull)." Power on reset defaults the Status_HOLDOVER pin to “uWire Readback.”  
Figure 9 illustrates the serial data timing sequence for a readback operation for both cases of READBACK_LE =  
0 (POR default) and READBACK_LE = 1.  
To perform a readback operation first set the register to be read back by programming the READBACK_ADDR  
register. Then after any MICROWIRE write operation, with the LEuWire pin held low continue to clock the  
CLKuWire pin. On every rising edge of the CLKuWire pin a new data bit is clocked onto the any pins  
programmed for uWire Readback. If the READBACK_LE bit is set, the LEuWire pin should be left high after  
LEuWire rising edge while continuing to clock the CLKuWire pin.  
It is allowable to perform a register read back in the same MICROWIRE operation which set the  
READBACK_ADDR register value.  
Data is clocked out MSB first. After 27 clocks all the data values will have been read and the read operation is  
complete. If READBACK_LE = 1, the LEuWire line may now be lowered. It is allowable for the CLKuWire pin to  
be clocked additional cycles, but the data on the readback pin will be invalid.  
CLKuWire must be low before the falling edge of LEuWire.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
49  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.5.3.1 Readback - Example  
To readback register R3 perform the following steps:  
Write R31 with READBACK_ADDR = 3; READBACK_LE = 0. DATAuWire and CLKuWire are toggled as  
shown in Figure 6 with new data being clocked in on rising edges of CLKuWire  
Toggle LEuWire high and then low as shown in Figure 6 and Figure 9. LEuWire is returned low because  
READBACK_LE = 0.  
Toggle CLKuWire high and then low 27 times to read back all 27 bits of register R3. Data is read MSB first.  
Data is valid on falling edge of CLKuWire.  
Read operation is complete.  
50  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6 Register Maps  
8.6.1 Register Map and Readback Register Map  
Table 16 provides the register map for device programming. Normally any register can be read from the same data address it is written to. However,  
READBACK_LE has a different readback address. Also, the DAC_CNT register is a read only register. Table 17 shows the address for  
READBACK_LE and DAC_CNT. Bits marked as reserved are undefined upon readback.  
Observe that only the DATA bits are readback during a readback which can result in an offset of 5 bits between the two register tables.  
Table 16. Register Map  
REG-  
ISTER  
31  
30  
29  
28  
27  
26  
25  
24  
23  
22  
21  
20  
19  
18  
17  
16  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Data [26:0]  
Address [4:0]  
R0  
0
CLKout0_1_DDLY [27:18]  
CLKout2_3_DDLY [27:18]  
CLKout4_5_DDLY [27:18]  
CLKout0_1_DIV [15:5]  
CLKout2_3_DIV [15:5]  
CLKout4_5_DIV [15:5]  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R1  
0
0
0
0
1
R2  
0
0
0
0
1
0
R3  
CLKout6_7_DDLY [27:18]  
0
CLKout6_7_DIV [15:5]  
0
0
0
1
1
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
51  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Register Maps (continued)  
Table 16. Register Map (continued)  
REG-  
ISTER  
31  
30  
29  
28  
27  
26  
25  
24  
23  
22  
21  
20  
19  
18  
17  
16  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Data [26:0]  
Address [4:0]  
R4  
CLKout8_9_DDLY [27:18]  
0
CLKout8_9_DIV [15:5]  
0
0
1
0
0
R5  
0
CLKout10_11_DDLY [27:18]  
0
CLKout10_11_DIV [15:5]  
0
0
1
0
1
CLKout2_3_ADLY  
[15:11]  
CLKout0_1_ADLY  
[9:5]  
R6  
R7  
CLKout3_TYPE [31:28]  
CLKout7_TYPE [31:28]  
CLKout11_TYPE [31:28]  
CLKout2_TYPE [27:24]  
CLKout6_TYPE [27:24]  
CLKout10_TYPE [27:24]  
CLKout1_TYPE [23:20]  
CLKout0_TYPE [19:16]  
CLKout4_TYPE [19:16]  
CLKout8_TYPE [19:16]  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
CLKout6_7_ADLY  
[15:11]  
CLKout4_5_ADLY  
[9:5]  
CLKout5_TYPE [23:20]  
CLKout9_TYPE [23:20]  
CLKout10_11_ADLY  
[15:11]  
CLKout8_9_ADLY  
[9:5]  
R8  
R9  
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
OSCout1_  
LVPECL_  
AMP  
OSCout_DIV  
[18:16]  
VCO_DIV  
[10:8]  
FEEDBACK  
_MUX [7:5]  
R10  
0
1
OSCout0_TYPE [27:24]  
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
[31:30]  
SYNC_MUX  
[19:18]  
SYNC_TYPE  
[14:12]  
R11  
MODE [31:27]  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
52  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Register Maps (continued)  
Table 16. Register Map (continued)  
REG-  
ISTER  
31  
30  
29  
28  
27  
26  
25  
24  
23  
22  
21  
20  
19  
18  
17  
16  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Data [26:0]  
Address [4:0]  
HOLDOVER  
_MODE  
[7:6]  
0
R12  
LD_MUX [31:27]  
LD_TYPE [26:24]  
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
(1)  
Status_  
CLKin1  
_MUX  
Status_  
CLKin0  
_TYPE  
[18:16]  
Status_  
CLKin0  
_MUX  
CLKin  
_Select  
_MODE  
[11:8]  
HOLDOVER  
_TYPE  
[26:24]  
HOLDOVER_MUX  
[31:27]  
R13  
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
[22:20]  
[14:12]  
Status_  
CLKin1  
_TYPE  
[26:24]  
LOS_  
TIMEOUT  
[31:30]  
DAC_HIGH_TRIP  
[19:14]  
DAC_LOW_TRIP  
[11:6]  
R14  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
(1) Although the value of 0 is written here, during readback the value of READBACK_LE will be read at this location. See Register Map and Readback Register Map.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
53  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Register Maps (continued)  
Table 16. Register Map (continued)  
REG-  
ISTER  
31  
30  
29  
28  
27  
26  
25  
24  
23  
22  
21  
20  
19  
18  
17  
16  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Data [26:0]  
Address [4:0]  
MAN_DAC  
[31:22]  
HOLDOVER_DLD_CNT  
[19:6]  
R15  
R16  
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
XTAL_  
LVL  
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PLL1_  
PLL2_C4_LF  
[31:28]  
PLL2_C3_LF  
[27:24]  
PLL2_R4_LF  
[22:20]  
PLL2_R3_LF  
[18:16]  
PLL1_N_DLY  
[14:12]  
PLL1_R_DLY  
[10:8]  
WND_  
SIZE  
[7:6]  
R24  
R25  
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
DAC_CLK_DIV [31:22]  
0
0
0
PLL1_DLD_CNT [19:6]  
PLL2_  
WND_SIZE  
[31:30]  
PLL2_CP  
_GAIN  
[27:26]  
PLL2_DLD_CNT  
[19:6]  
R26  
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
PLL1_CP  
_GAIN  
[27:26]  
CLKin1_  
PreR_DIV  
[23: 22]  
CLKin0_  
PreR_DIV  
[21: 20]  
PLL1_R  
[19:6]  
R27  
R28  
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
PLL2_R [31: 20]  
PLL1_N [19:6]  
0
OSCin_FREQ  
[26:24]  
R29  
0
0
0
0
0
PLL2_N_CAL [22:5]  
1
1
1
0
1
R30  
R31  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PLL2_P [26:24]  
0
PLL2_N [22:5]  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
READBACK_ADDR [20:16]  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
54  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Table 17. Readback Register Map  
REG-  
ISTER  
RD  
26  
RD  
25  
RD  
24  
RD  
23  
RD  
22  
RD  
21  
RD  
20  
RD  
19  
RD  
18  
RD  
17  
RD  
16  
RD  
15  
RD  
14  
RD  
13  
RD  
12  
RD  
11  
RD  
10  
RD  
9
RD  
8
RD  
7
RD  
6
RD  
5
RD  
4
RD  
3
RD  
2
RD  
1
RD  
0
Data [26:0]  
HOLDOVER_  
MODE  
RD  
R12  
LD_MUX [26:22]  
LD_TYPE [21:19]  
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
[2:1]  
RD  
R23  
RESERVED [26:24]  
DAC_CNT [23:14]  
RESERVED [13:0]  
RD  
R31  
RESERVED [26:10]  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
55  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.2 Default Device Register Settings After Power On Reset  
Table 18 illustrates the default register settings programmed in silicon for the LMK0480x after power on or  
asserting the reset bit. Capital X and Y represent numeric values.  
Table 18. Default Device Register Settings after Power On/Reset  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(DECIMAL)  
BIT  
LOCATION  
(MSB:LSB)  
FIELD NAME  
DEFAULT STATE  
FIELD DESCRIPTION  
REGISTER  
CLKout0_1_PD  
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
PD  
PD  
R0  
R1  
CLKout2_3_PD  
CLKout4_5_PD  
PD  
R2  
Powerdown control for analog and digital delay,  
divider, and both output buffers  
31  
CLKout6_7_PD  
Normal  
Normal  
PD  
R3  
CLKout8_9_PD  
R4  
CLKout10_11_PD  
CLKout6_7_OSCin_Sel  
CLKout8_9_OSCin_Sel  
CLKoutX_ADLY_SEL  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY  
RESET  
R5  
OSCin  
VCO  
R3  
30  
30  
Selects the clock source for a clock group from  
internal VCO or external OSCin  
R4  
None  
5
Add analog delay for clock output  
Digital delay value  
R0 to R5  
R0 to R5  
R0  
28, 29  
27:18 [10]  
17  
Not in reset  
Performs power on reset for device  
Disabled  
(device is active)  
POWERDOWN  
0
Device power down control  
Half shift for digital delay  
R1  
17  
16  
CLKoutX_Y_HS  
CLKout0_1_DIV  
CLKout2_3_DIV  
CLKout4_5_DIV  
CLKout6_7_DIV  
CLKout8_9_DIV  
CLKout10_11_DIV  
CLKout3_TYPE  
CLKout7_TYPE  
CLKout11_TYPE  
CLKout2_TYPE  
0
25  
25  
25  
1
No shift  
R0 to R5  
R0  
Divide-by-25  
Divide-by-25  
Divide-by-25  
Divide-by-1  
Divide-by-25  
Divide-by-25  
Powerdown  
Powerdown  
Powerdown  
Powerdown  
R1  
R2  
Divide for clock outputs  
15:5 [11]  
R3  
25  
25  
0
R4  
R5  
R6  
0
R7  
31:28 [4]  
27:24 [4]  
0
R8  
0
R6  
LVCMOS  
(Norm/Norm)  
CLKout6_TYPE  
8
R7  
Individual clock output format. Select from  
LVDS/LVPECL/LVCMOS.  
CLKout10_TYPE  
CLKout1_TYPE  
CLKout5_TYPE  
CLKout9_TYPE  
CLKout0_TYPE  
CLKout4_TYPE  
CLKout8_TYPE  
CLKoutX_Y_ADLY  
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
Powerdown  
Powerdown  
Powerdown  
Powerdown  
Powerdown  
Powerdown  
LVDS  
R8  
R6  
R7  
23:20 [4]  
19:16 [4]  
R8  
R6  
R7  
R8  
No delay  
Analog delay setting for clock group  
Set LVPECL amplitude  
R6 to R8  
15:11, 9:5 [5]  
31:30 [2]  
1600 mVpp  
LVPECL  
OSCout1_LVPECL_AMP  
2
R10  
OSCout0_TYPE  
EN_OSCout1  
EN_OSCout0  
OSCout1_MUX  
OSCout0_MUX  
1
0
1
0
0
LVDS  
Disabled  
OSCout0 default clock output  
R10  
R10  
R10  
R10  
R10  
27:24 [4]  
Disable OSCout1 output buffer  
23  
22  
21  
20  
Enabled  
Enable OSCout0 output buffer  
Bypass Divider  
Bypass Divider  
Select OSCout divider for OSCout1 or bypass  
Select OSCout divider for OSCout0 or bypass  
Allows OSCin to be powered down. For use in clock  
distribution mode.  
PD_OSCin  
0
0
OSCin powered  
Divide-by-8  
R10  
R10  
19  
OSCout_DIV  
OSCout divider value  
18:16 [3]  
56  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Table 18. Default Device Register Settings after Power On/Reset (continued)  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(DECIMAL)  
BIT  
LOCATION  
(MSB:LSB)  
FIELD NAME  
DEFAULT STATE  
FIELD DESCRIPTION  
REGISTER  
VCO_MUX  
0
0
2
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
VCO  
Select VCO or VCO Divider output  
Feedback MUX is powered down.  
VCO Divide value  
R10  
R10  
R10  
R10  
R11  
R11  
R11  
R11  
R11  
R11  
R11  
R11  
R11  
12  
11  
EN_FEEDBACK_MUX  
VCO_DIV  
Disabled  
Divide-by-2  
CLKout0  
10:8 [3]  
7:5 [3]  
31:27 [5]  
26  
FEEDBACK_MUX  
MODE  
Selects CLKout to feedback into the PLL1 N divider  
Device mode  
Internal VCO  
Enabled  
EN_SYNC  
Enables synchronization circuitry.  
NO_SYNC_CLKout10_11  
NO_SYNC_CLKout8_9  
NO_SYNC_CLKout6_7  
NO_SYNC_CLKout4_5  
NO_SYNC_CLKout2_3  
NO_SYNC_CLKout0_1  
SYNC_MUX  
Will sync  
25  
Will not sync  
Will not sync  
Will sync  
24  
23  
Disable individual clock groups from becoming  
synchronized.  
22  
Will sync  
21  
Will sync  
20  
Logic Low  
Mux controlling SYNC pin when set to output  
19:18 [2]  
Allows SYNC operations to be qualified by a clock  
output.  
SYNC_QUAL  
0
1
0
Not qualified  
Logic Low  
Manual  
R11  
R11  
R11  
17  
16  
15  
SYNC_POL_INV  
SYNC_EN_AUTO  
Sets the polarity of the SYNC pin when input  
SYNC is not started by programming a register R0 to  
R5.  
Input /w  
Pull-up  
SYNC_TYPE  
1
SYNC IO pin type  
R11  
14:12 [3]  
EN_PLL2_XTAL  
LD_MUX  
0
3
Disabled  
Enable Crystal oscillator for OSCin  
R11  
R12  
5
PLL1 and 2 DLD Lock detect mux selection when output  
31:27 [5]  
Output  
LD_TYPE  
3
LD IO pin type  
(Push-Pull)  
R12  
26:24 [3]  
SYNC_PLL2_DLD  
SYNC_PLL1_DLD  
EN_TRACK  
0
0
1
2
7
Normal  
Normal  
Force synchronization mode until PLL2 locks  
Force synchronization mode until PLL1 locks  
R12  
R12  
R12  
R12  
R13  
23  
22  
Enable Tracking DAC tracking of the PLL1 tuning voltage  
Enable Holdover Causes holdover to activate when lock is lost  
uWire Readback Holdover mux selection  
8
HOLDOVER_MODE  
HOLDOVER_MUX  
7:6 [2]  
31:27 [5]  
Output  
HOLDOVER_TYPE  
3
HOLDOVER IO pin type  
(Push-Pull)  
R13  
26:24 [3]  
Status_CLKin1_MUX  
Status_CLKin0_TYPE  
0
2
Logic Low  
Status_CLKin1 pin MUX selection  
R13  
R13  
22:20 [3]  
18:16 [3]  
Input /w Pull-down Status_CLKin0 IO pin type  
Disables PLL1 DLD falling edge from causing  
DISABLE_DLD1_DET  
0
Not Disabled  
R13  
15  
HOLDOVER mode to be entered  
Status_CLKin0 pin MUX selection  
Mode to use in determining reference CLKin for PLL1  
Invert Status 0 and 1 pin polarity for input(1)  
Set CLKin1 to be usable  
Status_CLKin0_MUX  
CLKin_SELECT_MODE  
CLKin_Sel_INV  
EN_CLKin1  
0
3
0
1
1
0
1
2
0
0
Logic Low  
Manual Select  
Active High  
Usable  
R13  
R13  
R13  
R13  
R13  
R14  
R14  
R14  
R14  
R14  
14:12 [3]  
11:9 [3]  
8
6
EN_CLKin0  
Usable  
Set CLKin0 to be usable  
5
31:30 [2]  
28  
LOS_TIMEOUT  
EN_LOS  
1200 ns, 420 kHz Time until no activity on CLKin asserts LOS  
Enabled Loss of Signal Detect at CLKin  
Input /w Pull-down Status_CLKin1 pin IO pin type  
Status_CLKin1_TYPE  
CLKin1_BUF_TYPE  
CLKin0_BUF_TYPE  
26:24 [3]  
21  
Bipolar  
Bipolar  
CLKin1 Buffer Type  
CLKin0 Buffer Type  
20  
(1) Inversion for Status 0 and 1 pins is only valid for CLKin_SELECT_MODE = 0x06  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
57  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Table 18. Default Device Register Settings after Power On/Reset (continued)  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(DECIMAL)  
BIT  
LOCATION  
(MSB:LSB)  
FIELD NAME  
DEFAULT STATE  
FIELD DESCRIPTION  
REGISTER  
Voltage from Vcc at which holdover mode is entered if  
EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DAC is enabled.  
DAC_HIGH_TRIP  
0
0
0
~50 mV from Vcc  
~50 mV from GND  
Disabled  
R14  
R14  
R14  
19:14 [6]  
11:6 [6]  
5
Voltage from GND at which holdover mode is entered  
if EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DAC is enabled.  
DAC_LOW_TRIP  
Enable PLL1 unlock state when DAC trip points are  
achieved  
EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DET  
Writing to this register will set the value for DAC when  
in manual override.  
MAN_DAC  
512  
3 V / 2  
R15  
31:22 [10]  
Readback from this register is DAC value.  
EN_MAN_DAC  
0
Disabled  
Set manual DAC override  
R15  
R15  
20  
Lock must be valid n many clocks of PLL1 PDF before  
holdover mode is exited.  
HOLDOVER_DLD_CNT  
512  
512 counts  
19:6 [14]  
Holdover not  
forced  
FORCE_HOLDOVER  
0
Forces holdover mode.  
R15  
5
XTAL_LVL  
0
0
0
0
0
1.65 Vpp  
10 pF  
Sets drive power level of Crystal  
PLL2 integrated capacitor C4 value  
PLL2 integrated capacitor C3 value  
PLL2 integrated resistor R4 value  
PLL2 integrated resistor R3 value  
R16  
R24  
R24  
R24  
R24  
31:30 [2]  
31:28 [4]  
27:24 [4]  
22:20 [3]  
18:16 [3]  
PLL2_C4_LF  
PLL2_C3_LF  
PLL2_R4_LF  
PLL2_R3_LF  
10 pF  
200 Ω  
200 Ω  
Delay in PLL1 feedback path to decrease lag from  
input to output  
PLL1_N_DLY  
0
No delay  
R24  
14:12 [3]  
Delay in PLL1 reference path to increase lag from  
input to output  
PLL1_R_DLY  
0
3
4
No delay  
40 ns  
R24  
R24  
R25  
10:8 [3]  
7:6 [2]  
PLL1_WND_SIZE  
DAC_CLK_DIV  
Window size used for digital lock detect for PLL1  
DAC update clock divisor. Divides PLL1 phase  
detector frequency.  
Divide-by-4  
31:22 [10]  
Lock must be valid n many cycles before LD is  
asserted  
PLL1_DLD_CNT  
PLL2_WND_SIZE  
1024  
0
1024 cycles  
R25  
R26  
19:6 [14]  
31:30 [2]  
Reserved  
Window size used for digital lock detect for PLL2  
(2)  
EN_PLL2_REF_2X  
PLL2_CP_POL  
0
0
3
Disabled, 1x  
Negative  
3.2 mA  
Doubles reference frequency of PLL2.  
Polarity of PLL2 Charge Pump  
PLL2 Charge Pump Gain  
R26  
R26  
R26  
29  
28  
PLL2_CP_GAIN  
27:26 [2]  
Number of PDF cycles which phase error must be  
within DLD window before LD state is asserted.  
PLL2_DLD_CNT  
8192  
8192 Counts  
R26  
19:6 [14]  
PLL2_CP_TRI  
PLL1_CP_POL  
PLL1_CP_GAIN  
CLKin1_PreR_DIV  
CLKin0_PreR_DIV  
PLL1_R  
0
1
Active  
Positive  
PLL2 Charge Pump Active  
R26  
R27  
R27  
R27  
R27  
R27  
R27  
R28  
R28  
R29  
5
Polarity of PLL1 Charge Pump  
PLL1 Charge Pump Gain  
28  
0
100 uA  
27:26 [2]  
23:22 [2]  
21:20 [2]  
19:6 [14]  
5
0
Divide-by-1  
Divide-by-1  
Divide-by-96  
Active  
CLKin1 Pre-R divide value (1, 2, 4, or 8)  
CLKin0 Pre-R divide value (1, 2, 4, or 8)  
PLL1 R Divider (1 to 16383)  
PLL1 Charge Pump Active  
0
96  
0
PLL1_CP_TRI  
PLL2_R  
4
Divide-by-4  
Divide-by-192  
448 to 511 MHz  
PLL2 R Divider (1 to 4095)  
31:20 [12]  
19:6 [14]  
26:24 [3]  
PLL1_N  
192  
7
PLL1 N Divider (1 to 16383)  
OSCin frequency range  
OSCin_FREQ  
PLL2 PDF > 100 When set, PLL2 PDF of greater than 100 MHz may be  
PLL2_FAST_PDF  
PLL2_N_CAL  
1
R29  
R29  
23  
MHz  
used  
Actual PLL2 N divider value used in calibration  
routine.  
48  
Divide-by-48  
22:5 [18]  
PLL2_P  
PLL2_N  
2
Divide-by-2  
PLL2 N Divider Prescaler (2 to 8)  
PLL2 N Divider (1 to 262143)  
R30  
R30  
26:24 [3]  
22:5 [18]  
48  
Divide-by-48  
(2) This register must be reprogrammed to a value of 2 (3.7 ns) during user programming.  
58  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Table 18. Default Device Register Settings after Power On/Reset (continued)  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(DECIMAL)  
BIT  
LOCATION  
(MSB:LSB)  
FIELD NAME  
DEFAULT STATE  
FIELD DESCRIPTION  
REGISTER  
LEuWire Low for  
Readback  
READBACK_LE  
0
State LEuWire pin must be in for readback  
R31  
21  
READBACK_ADDR  
uWire_LOCK  
31  
0
Register 31  
Writable  
Register to read back  
R31  
R31  
20:16 [5]  
5
The values of registers R0 to R30 are lockable  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
59  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3 Register Descriptions  
8.6.3.1 Register R0 TO R5  
Registers R0 through R5 control the 12 clock outputs CLKout0 to CLKout11. Register R0 controls CLKout0 and  
CLKout1, Register R1 controls CLKout2 and CLKout3, and so on. All functions of the bits in these six registers  
are identical except the different registers control different clock outputs. The X and Y in CLKoutX_Y_PD,  
CLKoutX_ADLY_SEL, CLKoutY_ADLY_SEL, CLKoutX_Y_DDLY, CLKoutX_Y_HS, CLKoutX_Y_DIV denote the  
actual clock output which may be from 0 to 11 where X is even and Y is odd. Two clock outputs CLKoutX and  
CLKoutY form a clock output group and are often run together in bit names as CLKoutX_Y.  
The RESET bit is only in register R0.  
The POWERDOWN bit is only in register R1.  
The CLKoutX_Y_OSCin_Sel bit is only in registers R3 and R4.  
8.6.3.1.1 CLKoutX_Y_PD, Powerdown CLKoutX_Y Output Path  
This bit powers down the clock group as specified by CLKoutX and CLKoutY. This includes the divider, digital  
delay, analog delay, and output buffers.  
Table 19. CLKoutX_Y_PD  
R0-R5[31]  
STATE  
0
1
Power up clock group  
Power down clock group  
8.6.3.1.2 CLKoutX_Y_OSCin_Sel, Clock Group Source  
This bit sets the source for the clock output group CLKoutX_Y. The selected source will be either from a VCO via  
Mode Mux1 or from the OSCin buffer.  
This bit is valid only for registers R3 and R4, clock groups CLKout6_7 and CLKout8_9 respectively. All other  
clock output groups are driven by a VCO via Mode Mux1.  
Table 20. CLKoutX_Y_OSCin_Sel  
R3-R4[30]  
CLOCK GROUP SOURCE  
0
1
VCO  
OSCin  
60  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.1.3 CLKoutY_ADLY_SEL[29], CLKoutX_ADLY_SEL[28], Select Analog Delay  
These bits individually select the analog delay block (CLKoutX_Y_ADLY) for use with CLKoutX or CLKoutY. It is  
not required for both outputs of a clock output group to use analog delay, but if both outputs do select the analog  
delay block, then the analog delay will be the same for each output, CLKoutX and CLKoutY. When neither clock  
output uses analog delay, the analog delay block is powered down. Analog delay may not operate at frequencies  
above the minimum-ensured maximum output frequency of 1536 MHz.  
Table 21. CLKoutY_ADLY_SEL[29], CLKoutX_ADLY_SEL[28]  
R0-R5[29]  
R0-R5[28]  
STATE  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Analog delay powered down  
Analog delay on even CLKoutX  
Analog delay on odd CLKoutY  
Analog delay on both CLKouts  
8.6.3.1.4 CLKoutX_Y_DDLY, Clock Channel Digital Delay  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY and CLKoutX_Y_HS sets the digital delay used for CLKoutX and CLKoutY. This value only  
takes effect during a SYNC event and if the NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bit is cleared for this clock group. See Clock  
Output Synchronization (SYNC).  
Programming CLKoutX_Y_DDLY can require special attention. See section Special Programming Case for R0 to  
R5 for CLKoutX_Y_DIV and CLKoutX_Y_DDLY for more details.  
Using a CLKoutX_Y_DDLY value of 13 or greater will cause the clock group to operate in extended mode  
regardless of the clock group's divide value or the half step value.  
One clock cycle is equal to the period of the clock distribution path. The period of the clock distribution path is  
equal to VCO Divider value divided by the frequency of the VCO. If the VCO divider is disabled or an external  
VCO is used, the VCO divide value is treated as 1.  
tclock distribution path = VCO divide value / fVCO  
Table 22. CLKoutX_Y_DDLY, 10 Bits  
R0-R5[27:18]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
...  
DELAY  
5 clock cycles  
5 clock cycles  
5 clock cycles  
5 clock cycles  
5 clock cycles  
5 clock cycles  
6 clock cycles  
7 clock cycles  
...  
POWER MODE  
Normal Mode  
12 (0x0C)  
13 (0x0D)  
...  
12 clock cycles  
13 clock cycles  
...  
520 (0x208)  
521 (0x209)  
522 (0x20A)  
520 clock cycles  
521 clock cycles  
522 clock cycles  
Extended Mode  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
61  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.1.5 Reset  
The RESET bit is located in register R0 only. Setting this bit will cause the silicon default values to be loaded.  
When programming register R0 with the RESET bit set, all other programmed values are ignored. After resetting  
the device, the register R0 must be programmed again (with RESET = 0) to set non-default values in register R0.  
The reset occurs on the falling edge of the LEuWire pin which loaded R0 with RESET = 1.  
The RESET bit is automatically cleared upon writing any other register. For instance, when R0 is written to again  
with default values.  
Table 23. RESET  
R0[17]  
STATE  
0
1
Normal operation  
Reset (automatically cleared)  
8.6.3.1.6 POWERDOWN  
The POWERDOWN bit is located in register R1 only. Setting the bit causes the device to enter powerdown  
mode. Normal operation is resumed by clearing this bit via MICROWIRE.  
Table 24. POWERDOWN  
R1[17]  
STATE  
0
1
Normal operation  
Powerdown  
8.6.3.1.7 CLKoutX_Y_HS, Digital Delay Half Shift  
This bit subtracts a half clock cycle of the clock distribution path period to the digital delay of CLKoutX and  
CLKoutY. CLKoutX_Y_HS is used together with CLKoutX_Y_DDLY to set the digital delay value.  
When changing CLKoutX_Y_HS, the digital delay immediately takes effect without a SYNC event.  
Table 25. CLKoutX_Y_HS  
R0-R5[16]  
STATE  
0
Normal  
Subtract half of a clock distribution path period from the total digital  
delay  
1
62  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.1.8 CLKoutX_Y_DIV, Clock Output Divide  
CLKoutX_Y_DIV sets the divide value for the clock group. The divide may be even or odd. Both even and odd  
divides output a 50% duty cycle clock.  
Using a divide value of 26 or greater will cause the clock group to operate in extended mode regardless of the  
clock group's digital delay value.  
Programming CLKoutX_Y_DIV can require special attention. See section Special Programming Case for R0 to  
R5 for CLKoutX_Y_DIV and CLKoutX_Y_DDLY for more details.  
Table 26. CLKoutX_Y_DIV, 11 Bits  
R0-R5[15:5]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
...  
DIVIDE VALUE  
POWER MODE  
Reserved  
(1)  
1
(2)  
2
3
(2)  
4
Normal Mode  
(2)  
5
6
...  
24 (0x18)  
25 (0x19)  
26 (0x1A)  
27 (0x1B)  
...  
24  
25  
26  
27  
...  
Extended Mode  
1044 (0x414)  
1045 (0x415)  
1044  
1045  
(1) CLKoutX_Y_HS must = 0 for divide by 1.  
(2) After programming PLL2_N value, a SYNC must occur on channels using this divide value. Programming PLL2_N does generate a  
SYNC event automatically which satisfies this requirement, but NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y must be set to 0 for these clock groups.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
63  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.2 Registers R6 TO R8  
Registers R6 to R8 set the clock output types and analog delays.  
8.6.3.2.1 CLKoutX_TYPE  
The clock output types of the LMK0480x are individually programmable. The CLKoutX_TYPE registers set the  
output type of an individual clock output to LVDS, LVPECL, LVCMOS, or powers down the output buffer. Note  
that LVPECL supports four different amplitude levels and LVCMOS supports single LVCMOS outputs, inverted,  
and normal polarity of each output pin for maximum flexibility.  
Table 27 shows at what register and address the specified clock output CLKoutX_TYPE register is located.  
The CLKoutX_TYPE table shows the programming definition for these registers.  
Table 27. CLKoutX_TYPE Programming Addresses  
CLKoutX  
CLKout0  
CLKout1  
CLKout2  
CLKout3  
CLKout4  
CLKout5  
CLKout6  
CLKout7  
CLKout8  
CLKout9  
CLKout10  
CLKout11  
PROGRAMMING ADDRESS  
R6[19:16]  
R6[23:20]  
R6[27:24]  
R6[31:28]  
R7[19:16]  
R7[23:20]  
R7[27:24]  
R7[31:28]  
R8[19:16]  
R8[23:20]  
R8[27:24]  
R8[31:28]  
Table 28. CLKoutX_TYPE, 4 Bits  
R6-R8[31:28, 27:24, 23:20]  
0 (0x00)  
DEFINITION  
Power down  
1 (0x01)  
LVDS  
2 (0x02)  
LVPECL (700 mVpp)  
LVPECL (1200 mVpp)  
LVPECL (1600 mVpp)  
LVPECL (2000 mVpp)  
LVCMOS (Norm/Inv)  
LVCMOS (Inv/Norm)  
LVCMOS (Norm/Norm)  
LVCMOS (Inv/Inv)(1)  
LVCMOS (Low/Norm)(1)  
LVCMOS (Low/Inv)(1)  
LVCMOS (Norm/Low)(1)  
LVCMOS (Inv/Low)(1)  
LVCMOS (Low/Low)(1)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
8 (0x08)  
9 (0x09)  
10 (0x0A)  
11 (0x0A)  
12 (0x0C)  
13 (0x0D)  
14 (0x0E)  
(1) To reduce supply switching and crosstalk noise, it is recommended to use a complementary LVCMOS output type such as 6 or 7. See  
Section Vcc2, Vcc3, Vcc10, Vcc11, Vcc12, Vcc13 (CLKout Vccs) for more information  
64  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.2.2 CLKoutX_Y_ADLY  
These registers control the analog delay of the clock group CLKoutX_Y. Adding analog delay to the output will  
increase the noise floor of the output. For this analog delay to be active for a clock output, it must be selected  
with CLKout(X or Y)_ADL_SEL. If neither clock output in a clock group selects the analog delay, then the analog  
delay block is powered down. Analog delay may not operate at frequencies above the minimum-ensured  
maximum output frequency of 1536 MHz.  
In addition to the programmed delay, a fixed 500 ps of delay will be added by engaging the delay block.  
The programming addresses table shows at what register and address the specified clock output  
CLKoutX_Y_ADLY register is located.  
The CLKoutX_Y_ADLY table shows the programming definition for these registers.  
Table 29. CLKoutX_Y_ADLY Programming Addresses  
CLKoutX_Y_ADLY  
CLKout0_1_ADLY  
CLKout2_3_ADLY  
CLKout4_5_ADLY  
CLKout6_7_ADLY  
CLKout8_9_ADLY  
CLKout10_11_ADLY  
PROGRAMMING ADDRESS  
R6[9:5]  
R6[15:11]  
R7[9:5]  
R7[15:11]  
R8[9:5]  
R8[15:11]  
Table 30. CLKoutX_Y_ADLY, 5 Bits  
R6-R8[15:11, 9:5]  
0 (0x00)  
DEFINITION  
500 ps + No delay  
500 ps + 25 ps  
500 ps + 50 ps  
500 ps + 75 ps  
500 ps + 100 ps  
500 ps + 125 ps  
500 ps + 150 ps  
500 ps + 175 ps  
500 ps + 200 ps  
500 ps + 225 ps  
500 ps + 250 ps  
500 ps + 275 ps  
500 ps + 300 ps  
500 ps + 325 ps  
500 ps + 350 ps  
500 ps + 375 ps  
500 ps + 400 ps  
500 ps + 425 ps  
500 ps + 450 ps  
500 ps + 475 ps  
500 ps + 500 ps  
500 ps + 525 ps  
500 ps + 550 ps  
500 ps + 575 ps  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
8 (0x08)  
9 (0x09)  
10 (0x0A)  
11 (0x0B)  
12 (0x0C)  
13 (0x0D)  
14 (0x0E)  
15 (0x0F)  
16 (0x10)  
17 (0x11)  
18 (0x12)  
19 (0x13)  
20 (0x14)  
21 (0x15)  
22 (0x16)  
23 (0x17)  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
65  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.3 Register R10  
8.6.3.3.1 OSCout1_LVPECL_AMP, LVPECL Output Amplitude Control  
The OSCout1 clock output can only be used as an LVPECL output type. OSCout1_LVPECL_AMP sets the  
LVPECL output amplitude of the OSCout1 clock output.  
Table 31. OSCout1_LVPECL_AMP, 2 Bits  
R10[31:30]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
OUTPUT FORMAT  
LVPECL (700 mVpp)  
LVPECL (1200 mVpp)  
LVPECL (1600 mVpp)  
LVPECL (2000 mVpp)  
8.6.3.3.2 OSCout0_TYPE  
The OSCout0 clock output has a programmable output type. The OSCout0_TYPE register sets the output type to  
LVDS, LVPECL, LVCMOS, or powers down the output buffer. Note that LVPECL supports four different  
amplitude levels and LVCMOS supports dual and single LVCMOS outputs with inverted, and normal polarity of  
each output pin for maximum flexibility.  
To turn on the output, the OSCout0_TYPE must be set to a non-power down setting and enabled with  
EN_OSCoutX, OSCout Output Enable.  
Table 32. OSCout0_TYPE, 4 Bits  
R10[27:24]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
8 (0x08)  
9 (0x09)  
10 (0x0A)  
11 (0x0B)  
12 (0x0C)  
13 (0x0D)  
14 (0x0E)  
DEFINITION  
Powerdown  
LVDS  
LVPECL (700 mVpp)  
LVPECL (1200 mVpp)  
LVPECL (1600 mVpp)  
LVPECL (2000 mVpp)  
LVCMOS (Norm/Inv)  
LVCMOS (Inv/Norm)  
LVCMOS (Norm/Norm)(1)  
LVCMOS (Inv/Inv)(1)  
LVCMOS (Low/Norm)(1)  
LVCMOS (Low/Inv)(1)  
LVCMOS (Norm/Low)(1)  
LVCMOS (Inv/Low)(1)  
LVCMOS (Low/Low)(1)  
(1) To reduce supply switching and crosstalk noise, it is recommended to use a complementary LVCMOS output type such as 6 or 7. See  
Vcc2, Vcc3, Vcc10, Vcc11, Vcc12, Vcc13 (CLKout Vccs) for more information"  
66  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.3.3 EN_OSCoutX, OSCout Output Enable  
EN_OSCoutX is used to enable an oscillator buffered output.  
Table 33. EN_OSCout1  
R10[23]  
OUTPUT STATE  
OSCout1 Disabled  
OSCout1 Enabled  
0
1
Table 34. EN_OSCout0  
R10[22]  
OUTPUT STATE  
OSCout0 Disabled  
OSCout0 Enabled  
0
1
OSCout0 note: In addition to enabling the output with EN_OSCout0. The OSCout0_TYPE must be programmed  
to a non-power down value for the output buffer to power up.  
8.6.3.3.4 OSCoutX_MUX, Clock Output Mux  
Sets OSCoutX buffer to output a divided or bypassed OSCin signal. The divisor is set by OSCout_DIV, Oscillator  
Output Divide.  
Table 35. OSCout1_MUX  
R10[21]  
MUX OUTPUT  
Bypass divider  
Divided  
0
1
Table 36. OSCout0_MUX  
R10[20]  
MUX OUTPUT  
Bypass divider  
Divided  
0
1
8.6.3.3.5 PD_OSCin, OSCin Powerdown Control  
Except in clock distribution mode, the OSCin buffer must always be powered up.  
In clock distribution mode, the OSCin buffer must be powered down if not used.  
Table 37. PD_OSCin  
R10[19]  
OSCin BUFFER  
0
1
Normal Operation  
Powerdown  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
67  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.3.6 OSCout_DIV, Oscillator Output Divide  
The OSCout divider can be programmed from 2 to 8. Divide by 1 is achieved by bypassing the divider with  
OSCoutX_MUX, Clock Output Mux.  
Note that OSCout_DIV will be in the PLL1 N feedback path if OSCout0_MUX selects divided as an output. When  
OSCout_DIV is in the PLL1 N feedback path, the OSCout_DIV divide value must be accounted for when  
programming PLL1 N.  
See PLL Programming for more information on programming PLL1 to lock.  
Table 38. OSCout_DIV, 3 Bits  
R10[18:16]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
DIVIDE  
8
2
2
3
4
5
6
7
8.6.3.3.7 VCO_MUX  
When the internal VCO is used, the VCO divider can be selected to divide the VCO output frequency to reduce  
the frequency on the clock distribution path. It is recommended to use the VCO directly unless:  
Very low output frequencies are required.  
If using the VCO divider results in three or more clock output divider/delays changing from extended to  
normal power mode, a small power savings may be achieved by using the VCO divider.  
A consequence of using the VCO divider is a small degradation in phase noise.  
Table 39. VCO_MUX  
R10[12]  
DEFINITION  
0
VCO selected  
1
VCO divider selected  
8.6.3.3.8 EN_FEEDBACK_MUX  
When using 0-delay or dynamic digital delay (SYNC_QUAL = 1), EN_FEEDBACK_MUX must be set to 1 to  
power up the feedback mux.  
Table 40. EN_FEEDBACK_MUX  
R10[11]  
DEFINITION  
0
1
Feedback mux powered down  
Feedback mux enabled  
68  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.3.9 VCO_DIV, VCO Divider  
Divide value of the VCO Divider.  
See PLL Programming for more information on programming PLL2 to lock.  
Table 41. VCO_DIV, 3 Bits  
R10[10:8]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
DIVIDE  
8
2
2
3
4
5
6
7
8.6.3.3.10 FEEDBACK_MUX  
When in 0-delay mode, the feedback mux selects the clock output to be fed back into the PLL1 N Divider.  
Table 42. FEEDBACK_MUX, 3 Bits  
R10[7:5]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
MUX OUTPUT  
CLKout0  
CLKout2  
CLKout4  
CLKout6  
CLKout8  
CLKout10  
FBCLKin/FBCLKin*  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
69  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.4 Register R11  
8.6.3.4.1 MODE: Device Mode  
MODE determines how the LMK0480x operates from a high level. Different blocks of the device can be powered  
up and down for specific application requirements from a dual loop architecture to clock distribution.  
The LMK0480x can operate in:  
Dual PLL mode with the internal VCO or an external VCO.  
Single PLL mode uses PLL2 and powers down PLL1. OSCin is used for PLL reference input.  
Clock Distribution mode allows use of CLKin1 to distribute to clock outputs CLKout0 through CLKout11, and  
OSCin to distribute to OSCout0, OSCout1, and optionally CLKout6 through CLKout9.  
For the PLL modes, deterministic phase delay with respect to the input can be achieved with the 0-delay mode.  
For the PLL modes it is also possible to use an external VCO.  
Table 43. MODE, 5 Bits  
R11[31:27]  
0 (0x00)  
VALUE  
Dual PLL, Internal VCO  
Reserved  
1 (0x01)  
Dual PLL, Internal VCO,  
0-Delay  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
Dual PLL, External VCO (Fin)  
Reserved  
Dual PLL, External VCO (Fin),  
0-Delay(1)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
PLL2, Internal VCO  
Reserved  
PLL2, Internal VCO,  
0–Delay  
8 (0x08)  
9 (0x09)  
10 (0x0A)  
11 (0x0B)  
12 (0x0C)  
13 (0x0D)  
14 (0x0E)  
15 (0x0F)  
16 (0x10)  
Reserved  
Reserved  
PLL2, External VCO (Fin)  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Dual PLL, External VCO (Fin), 0-Delay(2)  
Clock Distribution  
(1) Contact TI Applications for more information on using this mode.  
(2) See Mode 15 Additional Configurations for additional configuration steps required.  
70  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.4.2 EN_SYNC, Enable Synchronization  
The EN_SYNC bit (default on) must be enabled for synchronization to work. Synchronization is required for  
dynamic digital delay.  
The synchronization enable may be turned off once the clocks are operating to save current. If EN_SYNC is set  
after it has been cleared (a transition from 0 to 1), a SYNC is generated that can disrupt the active clock outputs.  
Setting the NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bits will prevent this SYNC pulse from affecting the output clocks. Setting the  
EN_SYNC bit is not a valid method for synchronizing the clock outputs. See the Clock Output Synchronization  
section for more information on synchronization.  
Table 44. EN_SYNC  
R11[26]  
DEFINITION  
0
1
Synchronization disabled  
Synchronization enabled  
8.6.3.4.3 NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y  
The NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bits prevent individual clock groups from becoming synchronized during a SYNC  
event. A reason to prevent individual clock groups from becoming synchronized is that during synchronization,  
the clock output is in a fixed low state or can have a glitch pulse.  
By disabling SYNC on a clock group, it will continue to operate normally during a SYNC event.  
Digital delay requires a SYNC operation to take effect. If NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y is set before a SYNC event, the  
digital delay value will be unused.  
Setting the NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bit has no effect on clocks already synchronized together.  
Table 45. NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y Programming Addresses  
NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y  
CLKout0 and 1  
PROGRAMMING ADDRESS  
R11:20  
R11:21  
R11:22  
R11:23  
R11:24  
R11:25  
CLKout2 and 3  
CLKout4 and 5  
CLKout6 and 7  
CLKout8 and 9  
CLKout10 and 11  
Table 46. NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y  
R11[25, 24, 23, 22, 21, 20]  
DEFINITION  
0
1
CLKoutX_Y will synchronize  
CLKoutX_Y will not synchronize  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
71  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.4.4 SYNC_MUX  
Mux controlling SYNC pin when type is an output.  
All the outputs logic is active high when SYNC_TYPE = 3 (Output). All the outputs logic is active low when  
SYNC_TYPE = 4 (Output Inverted). For example, when SYNC_MUX = 0 (Logic Low) and SYNC_TYPE = 3  
(Output) then SYNC outputs a logic low. When SYNC_MUX = 0 (Logic Low) and SYNC_TYPE = 4 (Output  
Inverted) then SYNC outputs a logic high.  
Table 47. SYNC_MUX, 2 Bits  
R11[19:18]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
SYNC PIN OUTPUT  
Logic Low  
Reserved  
Reserved  
uWire Readback  
8.6.3.4.5 SYNC_QUAL  
When SYNC_QUAL is set, clock outputs will be synchronized to an existing clock output selected by  
FEEDBACK_MUX. By using the NO_SYNC_CLKoutX_Y bits, selected clock outputs will not be interrupted  
during the SYNC event.  
Qualifying the SYNC by an output clock means that the pulse which turns the clock outputs off and on will have a  
fixed time relationship to the qualifying output clock.  
SYNC_QUAL = 1 requires CLKout4_5_PD = 0 for proper operation. CLKout4_TYPE and CLKout5_TYPE may be  
set to Powerdown mode.  
See Clock Output Synchronization (SYNC) for more information.  
Table 48. SYNC_QUAL  
R11[17]  
MODE  
0
No qualification  
Qualification by clock output from feedback mux  
(Must set  
1
CLKout4_5_PD = 0)  
8.6.3.4.6 SYNC_POL_INV  
Sets the polarity of the SYNC pin when input. When SYNC is asserted the clock outputs will transition to a low  
state.  
See Clock Output Synchronization (SYNC) for more information on SYNC. A SYNC event can be generated by  
toggling this bit through the MICROWIRE interface.  
Table 49. SYNC_POL_INV  
R11[16]  
POLARITY  
0
1
SYNC is active high  
SYNC is active low  
72  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.4.7 SYNC_EN_AUTO  
When set, causes a SYNC event to occur when programming register R0 to R5 to adjust digital delay values.  
The SYNC event will coincide with the LEuWire pin falling edge.  
Refer to Special Programming Case for R0 to R5 for CLKoutX_Y_DIV and CLKoutX_Y_DDLY for more  
information on possible special programming considerations when SYNC_EN_AUTO = 1.  
Table 50. SYNC_EN_AUTO  
R11[15]  
MODE  
0
1
Manual SYNC  
SYNC Internally Generated  
8.6.3.4.8 SYNC_TYPE  
Sets the IO type of the SYNC pin.  
Table 51. SYNC_TYPE, 3 Bits  
R11[14:12]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
POLARITY  
Input  
Input /w pull-up resistor  
Input /w pull-down resistor  
Output (push-pull)  
Output inverted (push-pull)  
Output (open source)  
Output (open drain)  
When in output mode, the SYNC input is forced to 0 regardless of the SYNC_MUX setting. A synchronization  
can then be activated by uWire by programming the SYNC_POL_INV register to active low to assert SYNC.  
SYNC can then be released by programming SYNC_POL_INV to active high. Using this uWire programming  
method to create a SYNC event saves the need for an IO pin from another device.  
8.6.3.4.9 EN_PLL2_XTAL  
If an external crystal is being used to implement a discrete VCXO, the internal feedback amplifier must be  
enabled with this bit in order to complete the oscillator circuit.  
Table 52. EN_PLL2_XTAL  
R11[5]  
OSCILLATOR AMPLIFIER STATE  
0
1
Disabled  
Enabled  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
73  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.5 Register R12  
8.6.3.5.1 LD_MUX  
LD_MUX sets the output value of the LD pin.  
All the outputs logic is active high when LD_TYPE = 3 (Output). All the outputs logic is active low when  
LD_TYPE = 4 (Output Inverted). For example, when LD_MUX = 0 (Logic Low) and LD_TYPE = 3 (Output) then  
Status_LD outputs a logic low. When LD_MUX = 0 (Logic Low) and LD_TYPE = 4 (Output Inverted) then  
Status_LD outputs a logic high.  
Table 53. LD_MUX, 5 Bits  
R12[31:27]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
8 (0x08)  
9 (0x09)  
10 (0x0A)  
11 (0x0B)  
12 (0x0C)  
13 (0x0D)  
14 (0x0E)  
15 (0x0F)  
16 (0x10)  
17 (0x11)  
18 (0x12)  
MODE  
Logic Low  
PLL1 DLD  
PLL2 DLD  
PLL1 and PLL2 DLD  
Holdover Status  
DAC Locked  
Reserved  
uWire Readback  
DAC Rail  
DAC Low  
DAC High  
PLL1_N  
PLL1_N/2  
PLL2 N  
PLL2 N/2  
PLL1_R  
PLL1_R/2  
(1)  
PLL2 R  
(1)  
PLL2 R/2  
(1) Only valid when HOLDOVER_MUX is not set to 2 (PLL2_DLD) or 3 (PLL1 and PLL2 DLD).  
8.6.3.5.2 LD_TYPE  
Sets the IO type of the LD pin.  
Table 54. LD_TYPE, 3 Bits  
R12[26:24]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
POLARITY  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Output (push-pull)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
Output inverted (push-pull)  
Output (open source)  
Output (open drain)  
74  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.5.3 SYNC_PLLX_DLD  
By setting SYNC_PLLX_DLD a SYNC mode will be engaged (asserted SYNC) until PLL1 and/or PLL2 locks.  
SYNC_QUAL must be 0 to use this functionality.  
Table 55. SYNC_PLL2_DLD  
R12[23]  
SYNC MODE FORCED  
0
1
No  
Yes  
Table 56. SYNC_PLL1_DLD  
R12[22]  
SYNC MODE FORCED  
0
1
No  
Yes  
8.6.3.5.4 EN_TRACK  
Enable the DAC to track the PLL1 tuning voltage. For optional use in in holdover mode.  
Tracking can be used to monitor PLL1 voltage by readback of DAC_CNT register in any mode.  
Table 57. EN_TRACK  
R12[8]  
DAC TRACKING  
Disabled  
0
1
Enabled  
8.6.3.5.5 HOLDOVER_MODE  
Enable the holdover mode.  
Table 58. HOLDOVER_MODE, 2 Bits  
R12[7:6]  
HOLDOVER MODE  
Reserved  
0
1
2
3
Disabled  
Enabled  
Reserved  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
75  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.6 Register R13  
8.6.3.6.1 HOLDOVER_MUX  
HOLDOVER_MUX sets the output value of the Status_Holdover pin.  
The outputs are active high when HOLDOVER_TYPE = 3 (Output). The outputs are active low when  
HOLDOVER_TYPE = 4 (Output Inverted).  
Table 59. HOLDOVER_MUX, 5 Bits  
R13[31:27]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
8 (0x08)  
9 (0x09)  
10 (0x0A)  
11 (0x0B)  
12 (0x0C)  
13 (0x0D)  
14 (0x0E)  
15 (0x0F)  
16 (0x10)  
17 (0x11)  
18 (0x12)  
DEFINITION  
Logic Low  
PLL1 DLD  
PLL2 DLD  
PLL1 and PLL2 DLD  
Holdover Status  
DAC Locked  
Reserved  
uWire Readback  
DAC Rail  
DAC Low  
DAC High  
PLL1 N  
PLL1 N/2  
PLL2 N  
PLL2 N/2  
PLL1 R  
PLL1 R/2  
(1)  
PLL2 R  
(1)  
PLL2 R/2  
(1) Only valid when LD_MUX is not set to 2 (PLL2_DLD) or 3 (PLL1 and PLL2 DLD).  
8.6.3.6.2 HOLDOVER_TYPE  
Sets the IO mode of the Status_Holdover pin.  
Table 60. HOLDOVER_TYPE, 3 Bits  
R13[26:24]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
POLARITY  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Output (push-pull)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
Output inverted (push-pull)  
Output (open source)  
Output (open drain)  
76  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.6.3 Status_CLKin1_MUX  
Status_CLKin1_MUX sets the output value of the Status_CLKin1 pin. If Status_CLKin1_TYPE is set to an input  
type, this register has no effect. This MUX register only sets the output signal.  
The outputs are active high when Status_CLKin1_TYPE = 3 (Output). The outputs are active low when  
Status_CLKin1_TYPE = 4 (Output Inverted).  
Table 61. Status_CLKin1_MUX, 3 Bits  
R13[22:20]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
DEFINITION  
Logic Low  
CLKin1 LOS  
CLKin1 Selected  
DAC Locked  
DAC Low  
DAC High  
uWire Readback  
8.6.3.6.4 Status_CLKin0_TYPE  
Status_CLKin0_TYPE sets the IO type of the Status_CLKin0 pin.  
Table 62. Status_CLKin0_TYPE, 3 Bits  
R13[18:16]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
DEFINITION  
Input  
Input /w pull-up resistor  
Input /w pull-down resistor  
Output (push-pull)  
Output inverted (push-pull)  
Output (open source)  
Output (open drain)  
8.6.3.6.5 DISABLE_DLD1_DET  
DISABLE_DLD1_DET disables the HOLDOVER mode from being activated when PLL1 lock detect signal  
transitions from high to low.  
When using Pin Select Mode as the input clock switch mode, this bit should normally be set.  
Table 63. DISABLE_DLD1_DET  
R13[15]  
HOLDOVER DLD1 DETECT  
PLL1 DLD causes clock switch event  
PLL1 DLD does not cause clock switch event  
0
1
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
77  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.6.6 Status_CLKin0_MUX  
CLKin0_MUX sets the output value of the Status_CLKin0 pin. If Status_CLKin0_TYPE is set to an input type, this  
register has no effect. This MUX register only sets the output signal.  
The outputs logic is active high when Status_CLKin0_TYPE = 3 (Output). The outputs logic is active low when  
Status_CLKin0_TYPE = 4 (Output Inverted).  
Table 64. Status_CLKin0_MUX, 3 Bits  
R13[14:12]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
DIVIDE  
Logic Low  
CLKin0 LOS  
CLKin0 Selected  
DAC Locked  
DAC Low  
DAC High  
uWire Readback  
8.6.3.6.7 CLKin_SELECT_MODE  
CLKin_SELECT_MODE sets the mode used in determining reference CLKin for PLL1.  
Table 65. CLKin_SELECT_MODE, 3 Bits  
R13[11:9]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
MODE  
CLKin0 Manual  
CLKin1 Manual  
Reserved  
Pin Select Mode  
Auto Mode  
Reserved  
Auto mode and next clock pin select  
Reserved  
8.6.3.6.8 CLKin_Sel_INV  
CLKin_Sel_INV sets the input polarity of Status_CLKin0 and Status_CLKin1 pins.  
Inversion for Status 0 and 1 pins is only valid for CLKin_SELECT_MODE = 0x06.  
Table 66. CLKin_Sel_INV  
R13[8]  
INPUT  
0
1
Active High  
Active Low  
78  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.6.9 EN_CLKinX  
Each clock input can individually be enabled to be used during auto-switching CLKin_SELECT_MODE. Clock  
input switching priority is always CLKin0 CLKin1.  
Table 67. EN_CLKin1  
R13[6]  
ENABLED  
No  
0
1
Yes  
Table 68. EN_CLKin0  
R13[5]  
ENABLED  
No  
0
1
Yes  
8.6.3.7 Register 14  
8.6.3.7.1 LOS_TIMEOUT  
This bit controls the amount of time in which no activity on a CLKin causes LOS (Loss-of-Signal) to be asserted.  
Table 69. LOS_TIMEOUT, 2 Bits  
R14[31:30]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
TIMEOUT  
1200 ns, 420 kHz  
206 ns, 2.5 MHz  
52.9 ns, 10 MHz  
23.7 ns, 22 MHz  
8.6.3.7.2 EN_LOS  
Enables the LOS (Loss-of-Signal) timeout control.  
Table 70. EN_LOS  
R14[28]  
LOS  
0
1
Disabled  
Enabled  
8.6.3.7.3 Status_CLKin1_TYPE  
Sets the IO type of the Status_CLKin1 pin.  
Table 71. Status_CLKin1_TYPE, 3 Bits  
R14[26:24]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
POLARITY  
Input  
Input /w pull-up resistor  
Input /w pull-down resistor  
Output (push-pull)  
Output inverted (push-pull)  
Output (open source)  
Output (open drain)  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
79  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.7.4 CLKinX_BUF_TYPE, PLL1 CLKinX/CLKinX* Buffer Type  
There are two input buffer types for the PLL1 reference clock inputs: either bipolar or CMOS. Bipolar is  
recommended for differential inputs such as LVDS and LVPECL. CMOS is recommended for DC coupled single  
ended inputs.  
When using bipolar, CLKinX and CLKinX* input pins must be AC coupled when using a differential or single  
ended input.  
When using CMOS, CLKinX and CLKinX* input pins may be AC or DC coupled with a differential input.  
When using CMOS in single ended mode, the unused clock input pin (CLKinX or CLKinX*) must be AC  
grounded. The used clock input pin (CLKinX* or CLKinX) may be AC or DC coupled to the signal source.  
The programming addresses table shows at what register and address the specified CLKinX_BUF_TYPE bit is  
located.  
The CLKinX_BUF_TYPE table shows the programming definition for these registers.  
Table 72. CLKinX_BUF_TYPE Programming Addresses  
CLKinX_BUF_TYPE  
CLKin1_BUF_TYPE  
CLKin0_BUF_TYPE  
PROGRAMMING ADDRESS  
R14[21]  
R14[20]  
Table 73. CLKinX_BUF_TYPE  
R14[21, 20]  
CLKinX BUFFER TYPE  
0
1
Bipolar  
CMOS  
8.6.3.7.5 DAC_HIGH_TRIP  
Voltage from Vcc at which holdover mode is entered if EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DAC is enabled. This will also set flags  
which can be monitored out Status_LD/Status_Holdover pins.  
Step size is ~51 mV  
Table 74. DAC_HIGH_TRIP, 6 Bits  
R14[19:14]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
...  
TRIP VOLTAGE FROM VCC (V)  
1 × Vcc / 64  
2 × Vcc / 64  
3 × Vcc / 64  
4 × Vcc / 64  
5 × Vcc / 64  
...  
61 (0x3D)  
62 (0x3E)  
63 (0x3F)  
62 × Vcc / 64  
63 × Vcc / 64  
64 × Vcc / 64  
80  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.7.6 DAC_LOW_TRIP  
Voltage from GND at which holdover mode is entered if EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DAC is enabled. This will also set  
flags which can be monitored out Status_LD/Status_Holdover pins.  
Step size is ~51 mV  
Table 75. DAC_LOW_TRIP, 6 Bits  
R14[11:6]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
...  
TRIP VOLTAGE from GND (V)  
1 × Vcc / 64  
2 × Vcc / 64  
3 × Vcc / 64  
4 × Vcc / 64  
5 × Vcc / 64  
...  
61 (0x3D)  
62 (0x3E)  
63 (0x3F)  
62 × Vcc / 64  
63 × Vcc / 64  
64 × Vcc / 64  
8.6.3.7.7 EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DET  
Enables the DAC Vtune rail detection. When the DAC achieves a specified Vtune, if this bit is enabled, the  
current clock input is considered invalid and an input clock switch event is generated.  
Table 76. EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DET  
R14[5]  
STATE  
Disabled  
Enabled  
0
1
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
81  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.8 REGISTER 15  
8.6.3.8.1 MAN_DAC  
Sets the DAC value when in manual DAC mode in ~3.2 mV steps.  
Table 77. MAN_DAC, 10 Bits  
R15[31:22]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
...  
DAC VOLTAGE  
0 × Vcc / 1023  
1 × Vcc / 1023  
2 × Vcc / 1023  
...  
1023 (0x3FF)  
1023 × Vcc / 1023  
8.6.3.8.2 EN_MAN_DAC  
This bit enables the manual DAC mode.  
Table 78. EN_MAN_DAC  
R15[20]  
DAC MODE  
Automatic  
Manual  
0
1
8.6.3.8.3 HOLDOVER_DLD_CNT  
Lock must be valid for this many clocks of PLL1 PDF before holdover mode is exited.  
Table 79. HOLDOVER_DLD_CNT, 14 Bits  
R15[19:6]  
0 (0x00)  
EXIT COUNTS  
Reserved  
1 (0x01)  
1
2
2 (0x02)  
...  
...  
16,383 (0x3FFF)  
16,383  
8.6.3.8.4 FORCE_HOLDOVER  
This bit forces the holdover mode.  
When holdover is forced, if in fixed CPout1 mode (EN_TRACK = 0 or 1, EN_MAN_DAC =1) , then the DAC will  
set the programmed MAN_DAC value. If in tracked CPout1 mode (EN_TRACK = 1, EN_MAN_DAC = 0,  
EN_VTUNE_RAIL_DET = 0), then the DAC will set the current tracked DAC value.  
Setting FORCE_HOLDOVER does not constitute a clock input switch event unless DISABLE_DLD1_DET = 0,  
since when in holdover mode, PLL1_DLD = 0 will trigger the clock input switch event.  
Table 80. FORCE_HOLDOVER  
R15[5]  
HOLDOVER  
Disabled  
0
1
Enabled  
82  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.9 Register 16  
8.6.3.9.1 XTAL_LVL  
Sets the peak amplitude on the tunable crystal.  
Increasing this value can improve the crystal oscillator phase noise performance at the cost of increased current  
and higher crystal power dissipation levels.  
Table 81. XTAL_LVL, 2 Bits  
R15[31:22]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
PEAK AMPLITUDE(1)  
1.65 Vpp  
1.75 Vpp  
1.90 Vpp  
2.05 Vpp  
(1) At crystal frequency of 20.48 MHz  
8.6.3.10 Register 23  
This register must not be programmed, it is a readback only register.  
8.6.3.10.1 DAC_CNT  
The DAC_CNT register is 10 bits in size and located at readback bit position R[23:14]. When using tracking  
mode for holdover, the DAC value can be readback at this address.  
8.6.3.11 Register 24  
8.6.3.11.1 PLL2_C4_LF, PLL2 Integrated Loop Filter Component  
Internal loop filter components are available for PLL2, enabling either 3rd or 4th order loop filters without  
requiring external components.  
Internal loop filter capacitor C4 can be set according to Table 82.  
Table 82. PLL2_C4_LF, 4 Bits  
R24[31:28]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
8 (0x08)  
9 (0x09)  
10 (0x0A)  
11 (0x0B)  
12 (0x0C)  
13 (0x0D)  
14 (0x0E)  
15 (0x0F)  
LOOP FILTER CAPACITANCE (pF)  
10 pF  
15 pF  
29 pF  
34 pF  
47 pF  
52 pF  
66 pF  
71 pF  
103 pF  
108 pF  
122 pF  
126 pF  
141 pF  
146 pF  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
83  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.11.2 PLL2_C3_LF, PLL2 Integrated Loop Filter Component  
Internal loop filter components are available for PLL2, enabling either 3rd or 4th order loop filters without  
requiring external components.  
Internal loop filter capacitor C3 can be set according to Table 83.  
Table 83. PLL2_C3_LF, 4 Bits  
R24[27:24]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
8 (0x08)  
9 (0x09)  
10 (0x0A)  
11 (0x0B)  
12 (0x0C)  
13 (0x0D)  
14 (0x0E)  
15 (0x0F)  
LOOP FILTER CAPACITANCE (pF)  
10 pF  
11 pF  
15 pF  
16 pF  
19 pF  
20 pF  
24 pF  
25 pF  
29 pF  
30 pF  
33 pF  
34 pF  
38 pF  
39 pF  
Reserved  
Reserved  
8.6.3.11.3 PLL2_R4_LF, PLL2 Integrated Loop Filter Component  
Internal loop filter components are available for PLL2, enabling either 3rd or 4th order loop filters without  
requiring external components.  
Internal loop filter resistor R4 can be set according to Table 84.  
Table 84. PLL2_R4_LF, 3 Bits  
R24[22:20]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
RESISTANCE  
200 Ω  
1 kΩ  
2 kΩ  
4 kΩ  
16 kΩ  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
84  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.11.4 PLL2_R3_LF, PLL2 Integrated Loop Filter Component  
Internal loop filter components are available for PLL2, enabling either 3rd or 4th order loop filters without  
requiring external components.  
Internal loop filter resistor R3 can be set according to Table 85.  
Table 85. PLL2_R3_LF, 3 Bits  
R24[18:16]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
RESISTANCE  
200 Ω  
1 kΩ  
2 kΩ  
4 kΩ  
16 kΩ  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
8.6.3.11.5 PLL1_N_DLY  
Increasing delay of PLL1_N_DLY will cause the outputs to lead from CLKinX. For use in 0-delay mode.  
Table 86. PLL1_N_DLY, 3 Bits  
R24[14:12]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
DEFINITION  
0 ps  
205 ps  
410 ps  
615 ps  
820 ps  
1025 ps  
1230 ps  
1435 ps  
8.6.3.11.6 PLL1_R_DLY  
Increasing delay of PLL1_R_DLY will cause the outputs to lag from CLKinX. For use in 0-delay mode.  
Table 87. PLL1_R_DLY, 3 Bits  
R24[10:8]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
DEFINITION  
0 ps  
205 ps  
410 ps  
615 ps  
820 ps  
1025 ps  
1230 ps  
1435 ps  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
85  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.11.7 PLL1_WND_SIZE  
PLL1_WND_SIZE sets the window size used for digital lock detect for PLL1. If the phase error between the  
reference and feedback of PLL1 is less than specified time, then the PLL1 lock counter increments.  
Refer to Digital Lock Detect Frequency Accuracy for more information.  
Table 88. PLL1_WND_SIZE, 2 Bits  
R24[7:6]  
DEFINITION  
5.5 ns  
0
1
2
3
10 ns  
18.6 ns  
40 ns  
86  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.12 Register 25  
8.6.3.12.1 DAC_CLK_DIV  
The DAC update clock frequency is the PLL1 phase detector frequency divided by the divisor listed in Table 89.  
Table 89. DAC_CLK_DIV, 10 Bits  
R25[31:22]  
0 (0x00)  
DIVIDE  
Reserved  
1 (0x01)  
1
2
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
3
...  
...  
1,022 (0x3FE)  
1,023 (0x3FF)  
1022  
1023  
8.6.3.12.2 PLL1_DLD_CNT  
The reference and feedback of PLL1 must be within the window of phase error as specified by PLL1_WND_SIZE  
for this many phase detector cycles before PLL1 digital lock detect is asserted.  
Refer to Digital Lock Detect Frequency Accuracy for more information.  
Table 90. PLL1_DLD_CNT, 14 Bits  
R25[19:6]  
0 (0x0000)  
1 (0x0001)  
2 (0x0002)  
3 (0x0003)  
...  
VALUE  
Reserved  
1
2
3
...  
16,382 (0x3FFE)  
16,383 (0x3FFF)  
16,382  
16,383  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
87  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.13 Register 26  
8.6.3.13.1 PLL2_WND_SIZE  
PLL2_WND_SIZE sets the window size used for digital lock detect for PLL2. If the phase error between the  
reference and feedback of PLL2 is less than specified time, then the PLL2 lock counter increments. This value  
must be programmed to 2 (3.7 ns).  
Refer to Digital Lock Detect Frequency Accuracy for more information.  
Table 91. PLL2_WND_SIZE, 2 Bits  
R26[31:30]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
DEFINITION  
Reserved  
Reserved  
3.7 ns  
Reserved  
8.6.3.13.2 EN_PLL2_REF_2X, PLL2 Reference Frequency Doubler  
Enabling the PLL2 reference frequency doubler allows for higher phase detector frequencies on PLL2 than would  
normally be allowed with the given VCXO or Crystal frequency.  
Higher phase detector frequencies reduces the PLL N values which makes the design of wider loop bandwidth  
filters possible.  
Table 92. EN_PLL2_REF_2X  
R26[29]  
DESCRIPTION  
0
1
Reference frequency normal  
Reference frequency doubled (2x). See PLL2 Frequency Doubler  
8.6.3.13.3 PLL2_CP_POL, PLL2 Charge Pump Polarity  
PLL2_CP_POL sets the charge pump polarity for PLL2. The internal VCO requires the negative charge pump  
polarity to be selected. Many VCOs use positive slope.  
A positive slope VCO increases output frequency with increasing voltage. A negative slope VCO decreases  
output frequency with increasing voltage.  
Table 93. PLL2_CP_POL  
R26[28]  
DESCRIPTION  
0
1
Negative Slope VCO/VCXO  
Positive Slope VCO/VCXO  
88  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.13.4 PLL2_CP_GAIN, PLL2 Charge Pump Current  
This bit programs the PLL2 charge pump output current level. Table 94 also illustrates the impact of the PLL2  
TRI-STATE bit in conjunction with PLL2_CP_GAIN.  
Table 94. PLL2_CP_GAIN, 2 Bits  
PLL2_CP_TRI  
R26[27:26]  
CHARGE PUMP CURRENT (µA)  
R26[5]  
X
1
0
0
0
0
Hi-Z  
100  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
400  
1600  
3200  
8.6.3.13.5 PLL2_DLD_CNT  
The reference and feedback of PLL2 must be within the window of phase error as specified by PLL2_WND_SIZE  
for PLL2_DLD_CNT cycles before PLL2 digital lock detect is asserted.  
Refer to Digital Lock Detect Frequency Accuracy for more information  
Table 95. PLL2_DLD_CNT, 14 Bits  
R26[19:6]  
0 (0x00)  
VALUE  
Reserved  
1 (0x01)  
1
2 (0x02)  
2
3
3 (0x003)  
...  
...  
16,382 (0x3FFE)  
16,383 (0x3FFF)  
16,382  
16,383  
8.6.3.13.6 PLL2_CP_TRI, PLL2 Charge Pump TRI-STATE  
This bit allows for the PLL2 charge pump output pin, CPout2, to be placed into TRI-STATE.  
Table 96. PLL2_CP_TRI  
R26[5]  
DESCRIPTION  
0
1
PLL2 CPout2 is active  
PLL2 CPout2 is at TRI-STATE  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
89  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.14 REGISTER 27  
8.6.3.14.1 PLL1_CP_POL, PLL1 Charge Pump Polarity  
PLL1_CP_POL sets the charge pump polarity for PLL1. Many VCXOs use positive slope.  
A positive slope VCXO increases output frequency with increasing voltage. A negative slope VCXO decreases  
output frequency with increasing voltage.  
Table 97. PLL1_CP_POL  
R27[28]  
DESCRIPTION  
0
1
Negative Slope VCO/VCXO  
Positive Slope VCO/VCXO  
8.6.3.14.2 PLL1_CP_GAIN, PLL1 Charge Pump Current  
This bit programs the PLL1 charge pump output current level. Table 98 also illustrates the impact of the PLL1  
TRI-STATE bit in conjunction with PLL1_CP_GAIN.  
Table 98. PLL1_CP_GAIN, 2 Bits  
PLL1_CP_TRI  
R26[27:26]  
CHARGE PUMP CURRENT (µA)  
R27[5]  
X
1
0
0
0
0
Hi-Z  
100  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
200  
400  
1600  
8.6.3.14.3 CLKinX_PreR_DIV  
The pre-R dividers before the PLL1 R divider can be programmed such that when the active clock input is  
switched, the frequency at the input of the PLL1 R divider will be the same. This allows PLL1 to stay in lock  
without needing to re-program the PLL1 R register when different clock input frequencies are used. This is  
especially useful in the auto CLKin switching modes.  
Table 99. CLKinX_PreR_DIV Programming Addresses  
CLKinX_PreR_DIV  
CLKin1_PreR_DIV  
CLKin0_PreR_DIV  
PROGRAMMING ADDRESS  
R27[23:22]  
R27[21:20]  
Table 100. CLKinX_PreR_DIV, 2 Bits  
R27[23:22, 21:20]  
0 (0x00)  
DIVIDE  
1
2
4
8
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
90  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.14.4 PLL1_R, PLL1 R Divider  
The reference path into the PLL1 phase detector includes the PLL1 R divider. Refer to PLL Programming for  
more information on how to program the PLL dividers to lock the PLL.  
The valid values for PLL1_R are shown in Table 101.  
Table 101. PLL1_R, 14 Bits  
R27[19:6]  
0 (0x00)  
DIVIDE  
Reserved  
1 (0x01)  
1
2 (0x02)  
2
3
3 (0x03)  
...  
...  
16,382 (0x3FFE)  
16,383 (0x3FFF)  
16,382  
16,383  
8.6.3.14.5 PLL1_CP_TRI, PLL1 Charge Pump TRI-STATE  
This bit allows for the PLL1 charge pump output pin, CPout1, to be placed into TRI-STATE.  
Table 102. PLL1_CP_TRI  
R27[5]  
DESCRIPTION  
0
1
PLL1 CPout1 is active  
PLL1 CPout1 is at TRI-STATE  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
91  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.15 Register 28  
8.6.3.15.1 PLL2_R, PLL2 R Divider  
The reference path into the PLL2 phase detector includes the PLL2 R divider.  
Refer to PLL Programming for more information on how to program the PLL dividers to lock the PLL.  
The valid values for PLL2_R are shown in Table 103.  
Table 103. PLL2_R, 12 Bits  
R28[31:20]  
0 (0x00)  
DIVIDE  
Not Valid  
1 (0x01)  
1(1)  
.
See PLL2 Frequency Doubler  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
2
3
...  
...  
4,094 (0xFFE)  
4,095 (0xFFF)  
4,094  
4,095  
(1) When using PLL2_R divide value of 1, the PLL2 reference doubler should be used (EN_PLL2_REF_2X = 1).  
8.6.3.15.2 PLL1_N, PLL1 N Divider  
The feedback path into the PLL1 phase detector includes the PLL1 N divider.  
Refer to PLL Programming for more information on how to program the PLL dividers to lock the PLL.  
The valid values for PLL1_N are shown in Table 104.  
Table 104. PLL1_N, 14 Bits  
R28[19:6]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
...  
DIVIDE  
Not Valid  
1
2
...  
4,095 (0xFFF)  
4,095  
92  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.16 Register 29  
8.6.3.16.1 OSCin_FREQ, PLL2 Oscillator Input Frequency Register  
The frequency of the PLL2 reference input to the PLL2 Phase Detector (OSCin/OSCin* port) must be  
programmed in order to support proper operation of the frequency calibration routine which locks the internal  
VCO to the target frequency.  
Table 105. OSCin_FREQ, 3 Bits  
R29[26:24]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
OSCin FREQUENCY  
0 to 63 MHz  
>63 MHz to 127 MHz  
>127 MHz to 255 MHz  
Reserved  
>255 MHz to 400 MHz  
8.6.3.16.2 PLL2_FAST_PDF, High PLL2 Phase Detector Frequency  
When PLL2 phase detector frequency is greater than 100 MHz, set the PLL2_FAST_PDF to ensure proper  
operation of device.  
Table 106. PLL2_FAST_PDF  
R29[23]  
PLL2 PDF  
Less than or  
equal to 100 MHz  
0
1
Greater than 100 MHz  
8.6.3.16.3 PLL2_N_CAL, PLL2 N Calibration Divider  
During the frequency calibration routine, the PLL uses the divide value of the PLL2_N_CAL register instead of  
the divide value of the PLL2_N register to lock the VCO to the target frequency.  
NOTE: Unless in 0-delay mode, PLL2_N_CAL should be set equal to PLL2_N  
Refer to PLL Programming for more information on how to program the PLL dividers to lock the PLL.  
Table 107. PLL2_N_CAL, 18 Bits  
R29[22:5]  
0 (0x00)  
DIVIDE  
Not Valid  
1 (0x01)  
1
2 (0x02)  
2
...  
...  
262,143 (0x3FFFF)  
262,143  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
93  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.17 Register 30  
If an internal VCO mode is used, programming Register 30 triggers the frequency calibration routine. This  
calibration routine will also generate a SYNC event. See Clock Output Synchronization (SYNC) for more details  
on a SYNC.  
8.6.3.17.1 PLL2_P, PLL2 N Prescaler Divider  
The PLL2 N Prescaler divides the output of the VCO as selected by VCO_MUX and is connected to the PLL2 N  
divider.  
Refer to PLL Programming for more information on how to program the PLL dividers to lock the PLL.  
Table 108. PLL2_P, 3 Bits  
R30[26:24]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
DIVIDE VALUE  
8
2
2
3
4
5
6
7
8.6.3.17.2 PLL2_N, PLL2 N Divider  
The feeback path into the PLL2 phase detector includes the PLL2 N divider.  
Each time register 30 is updated via the MICROWIRE interface, a frequency calibration routine runs to lock the  
VCO to the target frequency. During this calibration PLL2_N is substituted with PLL2_N_CAL.  
Refer to PLL Programming for more information on how to program the PLL dividers to lock the PLL.  
The valid values for PLL2_N are shown in Table 109.  
Table 109. PLL2_N, 18 Bits  
R30[22:5]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
DIVIDE  
Not Valid  
1
2
...  
262,143 (0x3FFFF)  
262,143  
94  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
8.6.3.18 Register 31  
8.6.3.18.1 READBACK_LE  
Sets the required state of the LEuWire pin when performing register readback.  
Refer to Readback.  
Table 110. READBACK_LE  
R31[21]  
DEFINITION  
0
1
LE must be low for readback  
LE must be high for readback  
8.6.3.18.2 READBACK_ADDR  
Sets the address of the register to read back when performing readback.  
When reading register 12, the READBACK_ADDR will be read back at R12[20:16].  
When reading back from R31 bits 6 to 31 should be ignored. Only uWire_LOCK is valid.  
Refer to Register Readback for more information on readback.  
Table 111. READBACK_ADDR, 5 Bits  
R31[20:16]  
0 (0x00)  
1 (0x01)  
2 (0x02)  
3 (0x03)  
4 (0x04)  
5 (0x05)  
6 (0x06)  
7 (0x07)  
8 (0x08)  
9 (0x09)  
10 (0x0A)  
11 (0x0B)  
12 (0x0C)  
13 (0x0D)  
14 (0x0E)  
15 (0x0F)  
16 (0x10)  
17 (0x11)  
...  
REGISTER  
R0  
R1  
R2  
R3  
R4  
R5  
R6  
R7  
R8  
Reserved  
R10  
R11  
R12  
R13  
R14  
R15  
Reserved  
Reserved  
...  
22 (0x16)  
23 (0x17)  
24 (0x18)  
25 (0x19)  
26 (0x1A)  
27 (0x1B)  
28 (0x1C)  
29 (0x1D)  
30 (0x1E)  
31 (0x1F)  
Reserved  
Reserved  
R24  
R25  
R26  
R27  
R28  
R29  
R30  
R31  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
95  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
8.6.3.18.3 uWire_LOCK  
Setting uWire_LOCK will prevent any changes to uWire registers R0 to R30. Only by clearing the uWire_LOCK  
bit in R31 can the uWire registers be unlocked and written to once more.  
It is not necessary to lock the registers to perform a readback operation.  
Table 112. uWire_LOCK  
R31[5]  
STATE  
0
1
Registers unlocked  
Registers locked, Write-protect  
96  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
9 Application and Implementation  
NOTE  
Information in the following applications sections is not part of the TI component  
specification, and TI does not warrant its accuracy or completeness. TI’s customers are  
responsible for determining suitability of components for their purposes. Customers should  
validate and test their design implementation to confirm system functionality.  
9.1 Application Information  
To assist customers in frequency planning and design of loop filters, Texas Instruments provides the Clock  
Design Tool and Clock Architect.  
9.1.1 Loop Filter  
Each PLL of the LMK0480x family requires a dedicated loop filter.  
9.1.1.1 PLL1  
The loop filter for PLL1 must be connected to the CPout1 pin. Figure 20 shows a simple 2-pole loop filter. The  
output of the filter drives an external VCXO module or discrete implementation of a VCXO using a crystal  
resonator and external varactor diode. Higher order loop filters may be implemented using additional external R  
and C components. It is recommended the loop filter for PLL1 result in a total closed loop bandwidth in the range  
of 10 Hz to 200 Hz. The design of the loop filter is application specific and highly dependent on parameters such  
as the phase noise of the reference clock, VCXO phase noise, and phase detector frequency for PLL1. TI's  
Clock Conditioner Owner’s Manual covers this topic in detail and Texas Instruments Clock Design Tool can be  
used to simulate loop filter designs for both PLLs. These resources may be found at:  
http://www.ti.com/lsds/ti/analog/clocksandtimers/clocks_and_timers.page  
9.1.1.2 PLL2  
As shown in Figure 20, the charge pump for PLL2 is directly connected to the optional internal loop filter  
components, which are normally used only if either a third or fourth pole is needed. The first and second poles  
are implemented with external components. The loop must be designed to be stable over the entire application-  
specific tuning range of the VCO. The designer should note the range of KVCO listed in the table of Electrical  
Characteristics and how this value can change over the expected range of VCO tuning frequencies. Because  
loop bandwidth is directly proportional to KVCO, the designer should model and simulate the loop at the expected  
extremes of the desired tuning range, using the appropriate values for KVCO  
.
When designing with the integrated loop filter of the LMK0480x family, considerations for minimum resistor  
thermal noise often lead one to the decision to design for the minimum value for integrated resistors, R3 and R4.  
Both the integrated loop filter resistors (R3 and R4) and capacitors (C3 and C4) also restrict the maximum loop  
bandwidth. However, these integrated components do have the advantage that they are closer to the VCO and  
can therefore filter out some noise and spurs better than external components. For this reason, a common  
strategy is to minimize the internal loop filter resistors and then design for the largest internal capacitor values  
that permit a wide enough loop bandwidth. In situations where spur requirements are very stringent and there is  
margin on phase noise, a feasible strategy would be to design a loop filter with integrated resistor values larger  
than their minimum value.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
97  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Application Information (continued)  
LMK0480x PLL1  
LMK0480x PLL2  
PLL2 Internal Loop Filter  
Internal VCO  
PLL2  
Phase  
R3  
R4  
PLL1  
Phase  
Detector  
Detector  
C3  
C4  
CPout1  
CPout2  
External VCXO  
PLL1 External Loop  
PLL2 External Loop  
Filter  
Filter  
LF1_C2  
LF2_C2  
LF1_C1  
LF2_C1  
LF1_R2  
LF2_R2  
Figure 20. PLL1 and PLL2 Loop Filters  
9.1.2 Driving CLKin and OSCin Inputs  
9.1.2.1 Driving CLKin Pins with a Differential Source  
Both CLKin ports can be driven by differential signals. It is recommended that the input mode be set to bipolar  
(CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 0) when using differential reference clocks. The LMK0480x family internally biases the  
input pins so the differential interface should be AC coupled. The recommended circuits for driving the CLKin  
pins with either LVDS or LVPECL are shown in Figure 21 and Figure 22.  
CLKinX  
0.1 PF  
100:ꢀTrace  
LMK0480x  
Input  
LVDS  
(Differential)  
0.1 PF  
CLKinX*  
Figure 21. CLKinX/X* Termination for an LVDS Reference Clock Source  
CLKinX  
0.1 PF  
0.1 PF  
0.1 PF  
0.1 PF  
100:ꢀTrace  
(Differential)  
LVPECL  
Ref Clk  
LMK0480x  
Input  
CLKinX*  
Figure 22. CLKinX/X* Termination for an LVPECL Reference Clock Source  
Finally, a reference clock source that produces a differential sine wave output can drive the CLKin pins using the  
following circuit. Note: the signal level must conform to the requirements for the CLKin pins listed in Electrical  
Characteristics.  
98  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Application Information (continued)  
CLKinX  
0.1 PF  
0.1 PF  
100:ꢀTrace  
(Differential)  
LMK0480x  
Input  
Differential  
Sinewave Clock  
Source  
CLKinX*  
Figure 23. CLKinX/X* Termination for a Differential Sinewave Reference Clock Source  
9.1.2.2 Driving CLKin Pins with a Single-Ended Source  
The CLKin pins of the LMK0480x family can be driven using a single-ended reference clock source, for example,  
either a sine wave source or an LVCMOS/LVTTL source. Either AC coupling or DC coupling may be used. In the  
case of the sine wave source that is expecting a 50-Ω load, it is recommended that AC coupling be used as  
shown in Figure 24 with a 50-Ω termination.  
NOTE  
The signal level must conform to the requirements for the CLKin pins listed in Electrical  
Characteristics. CLKinX_BUF_TYPE in Register 11 is recommended to be set to bipolar  
mode (CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 0).  
0.1 PF  
50:ꢀTrace  
CLKinX  
50:  
LMK0480x  
Clock Source  
CLKinX*  
0.1 PF  
Figure 24. CLKinX/X* Single-Ended Termination  
If the CLKin pins are being driven with a single-ended LVCMOS/LVTTL source, either DC coupling or AC  
coupling may be used. If DC coupling is used, the CLKinX_BUF_TYPE should be set to MOS buffer mode  
(CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 1) and the voltage swing of the source must meet the specifications for DC coupled,  
MOS-mode clock inputs given in the table of Electrical Characteristics. If AC coupling is used, the  
CLKinX_BUF_TYPE should be set to the bipolar buffer mode (CLKinX_BUF_TYPE = 0). The voltage swing at  
the input pins must meet the specifications for AC coupled, bipolar mode clock inputs given in the table of  
Electrical Characteristics. In this case, some attenuation of the clock input level may be required. A simple  
resistive divider circuit before the AC coupling capacitor is sufficient.  
Figure 25. DC Coupled LVCMOS/LVTTL Reference Clock  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
99  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Application Information (continued)  
9.1.3 Termination and Use of Clock Output (Drivers)  
When terminating clock drivers keep in mind these guidelines for optimum phase noise and jitter performance:  
Transmission line theory should be followed for good impedance matching to prevent reflections.  
Clock drivers should be presented with the proper loads. For example:  
LVDS drivers are current drivers and require a closed current loop.  
LVPECL drivers are open emitters and require a DC path to ground.  
Receivers should be presented with a signal biased to their specified DC bias level (common mode voltage)  
for proper operation. Some receivers have self-biasing inputs that automatically bias to the proper voltage  
level. In this case, the signal should normally be AC coupled.  
It is possible to drive a non-LVPECL or non-LVDS receiver with an LVDS or LVPECL driver as long as the above  
guidelines are followed. Check the datasheet of the receiver or input being driven to determine the best  
termination and coupling method to be sure that the receiver is biased at its optimum DC voltage (common mode  
voltage). For example, when driving the OSCin/OSCin* input of the LMK0480x family, OSCin/OSCin* should be  
AC coupled because OSCin/OSCin* biases the signal to the proper DC level (See Figure 39) This is only slightly  
different from the AC coupled cases described in Driving CLKin Pins with a Single-Ended Source because the  
DC blocking capacitors are placed between the termination and the OSCin/OSCin* pins, but the concept remains  
the same. The receiver (OSCin/OSCin*) sets the input to the optimum DC bias voltage (common mode voltage),  
not the driver.  
9.1.3.1 Termination for DC Coupled Differential Operation  
For DC coupled operation of an LVDS driver, terminate with 100 Ω as close as possible to the LVDS receiver as  
shown in Figure 26.  
CLKoutX  
100:ꢀTrace  
(Differential)  
LVDS  
Receiver  
LVDS  
Driver  
CLKoutX*  
Figure 26. Differential LVDS Operation, DC Coupling, No Biasing of the Receiver  
For DC coupled operation of an LVPECL driver, terminate with 50 Ω to VCC - 2 V as shown in Figure 27.  
Alternatively, terminate with a Thevenin equivalent circuit (120-Ω resistor connected to VCC and an 82-Ω resistor  
connected to ground with the driver connected to the junction of the 120-Ω and 82-Ω resistors) as shown in  
Figure 28 for VCC = 3.3 V.  
Vcc - 2 V  
CLKoutX  
100:ꢀTrace  
(Differential)  
LVPECL  
Driver  
LVPECL  
Receiver  
CLKoutX*  
Vcc - 2 V  
Figure 27. Differential LVPECL Operation, DC Coupling  
100  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Application Information (continued)  
Vcc  
CLKoutX  
100:ꢀTrace  
(Differential)  
LVPECL  
Driver  
LVPECL  
Receiver  
CLKoutX*  
Vcc  
Figure 28. Differential LVPECL Operation, DC Coupling, Thevenin Equivalent  
9.1.3.2 Termination for AC Coupled Differential Operation  
AC coupling allows for shifting the DC bias level (common mode voltage) when driving different receiver  
standards. Since AC coupling prevents the driver from providing a DC bias voltage at the receiver it is important  
to ensure the receiver is biased to its ideal DC level.  
When driving non-biased LVDS receivers with an LVDS driver, the signal may be AC coupled by adding DC  
blocking capacitors, however the proper DC bias point needs to be established at the receiver. One way to do  
this is with the termination circuitry in Figure 29.  
0.1 PF  
100:ꢀTrace  
CLKoutX  
(Differential)  
LVDS  
Receiver  
LVDS  
Driver  
Vbias  
CLKoutX*  
0.1 PF  
Figure 29. Differential LVDS Operation, AC Coupling,  
External Biasing at the Receiver  
Some LVDS receivers may have internal biasing on the inputs. In this case, the circuit shown in Figure 29 is  
modified by replacing the 50-Ω terminations to Vbias with a single 100-Ω resistor across the input pins of the  
receiver, as shown in Figure 30. When using AC coupling with LVDS outputs, there may be a startup delay  
observed in the clock output due to capacitor charging. The previous figures employ a 0.1 µF capacitor. This  
value may need to be adjusted to meet the startup requirements for a particular application.  
0.1 PF  
100:ꢀTrace  
(Differential)  
LVDS  
Receiver  
LVDS  
Driver  
0.1 PF  
Figure 30. LVDS Termination for a Self-Biased Receiver  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
101  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Application Information (continued)  
LVPECL drivers require a DC path to ground. When AC coupling an LVPECL signal use 120-Ω emitter resistors  
close to the LVPECL driver to provide a DC path to ground as shown in Figure 31. For proper receiver operation,  
the signal should be biased to the DC bias level (common mode voltage) specified by the receiver. The typical  
DC bias voltage for LVPECL receivers is 2 V. A Thevenin equivalent circuit (82-Ω resistor connected to VCC and  
a 120-Ω resistor connected to ground with the driver connected to the junction of the 82-Ω and 120-Ω resistors)  
is a valid termination as shown in Figure 31 for VCC = 3.3 V. Note this Thevenin circuit is different from the DC  
coupled example in Figure 28.  
Vcc  
CLKoutX  
0.1 PF  
100:ꢀTrace  
(Differential)  
LVPECL  
Receiver  
LVPECL  
Driver  
0.1 PF  
CLKoutX*  
Vcc  
Figure 31. Differential LVPECL Operation, AC Coupling, Thevenin Equivalent,  
External Biasing at the Receiver  
9.1.3.3 Termination for Single-Ended Operation  
A balun can be used with either LVDS or LVPECL drivers to convert the balanced, differential signal into an  
unbalanced, single-ended signal.  
It is possible to use an LVPECL driver as one or two separate 800 mVpp signals. When using only one LVPECL  
driver of a CLKoutX/CLKoutX* pair, be sure to properly terminate the unused driver. When DC coupling one of  
the LMK0480x family clock LVPECL drivers, the termination should be 50 Ω to VCC - 2 V as shown in Figure 32.  
The Thevenin equivalent circuit is also a valid termination as shown in Figure 33 for Vcc = 3.3 V.  
Vcc - 2V  
CLKoutX  
50:ꢀTrace  
LVPECL  
Driver  
Vcc - 2V  
Load  
CLKoutX*  
50:  
Figure 32. Single-Ended LVPECL Operation, DC Coupling  
Vcc  
CLKoutX  
Vcc  
50:ꢀTrace  
LVPECL  
Driver  
CLKoutX*  
Load  
Figure 33. Single-Ended LVPECL Operation, DC Coupling,  
Thevenin Equivalent  
102  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Application Information (continued)  
When AC coupling an LVPECL driver use a 120-Ω emitter resistor to provide a DC path to ground and ensure a  
50-Ω termination with the proper DC bias level for the receiver. The typical DC bias voltage for LVPECL  
receivers is 2 V (See Driving CLKin Pins with a Single-Ended Source). If the companion driver is not used it  
should be terminated with either a proper AC or DC termination. This latter example of AC coupling a single-  
ended LVPECL signal can be used to measure single-ended LVPECL performance using a spectrum analyzer or  
phase noise analyzer. When using most RF test equipment no DC bias point (0 VDC) is required for safe and  
proper operation. The internal 50-Ω termination of the test equipment correctly terminates the LVPECL driver  
being measured as shown in Figure 34.  
CLKoutX  
50:ꢀTrace  
0.1 PF  
LVPECL  
Driver  
0.1 PF  
CLKoutX*  
Load  
Figure 34. Single-Ended LVPECL Operation, AC Coupling  
9.1.4 Frequency Planning with the LMK0480x Family  
Calculating the value of the output dividers for use with the LMK0480x family is simple due to the architecture of  
the LMK0480x. That is, the VCO divider may be bypassed and the clock output dividers allow for even and odd  
output divide values from 2 to 1045. For most applications it is recommended to bypass the VCO divider.  
The procedure for determining the needed LMK0480x device and clock output divider values for a set of clock  
output frequencies is straightforward.  
1. Calculate the least common multiple (LCM) of the clock output frequencies.  
2. Determine which VCO ranges will support the target clock output frequencies given the LCM.  
3. Determine the clock output divide values based on VCO frequency.  
4. Determine the PLL2_P, PLL2_N, and PLL2_R divider values given the OSCin VCXO or crystal frequency  
and VCO frequency.  
For example, given the following target output frequencies: 200 MHz, 120 MHz, and 25 MHz with a VCXO  
frequency of 40 MHz:  
First determine the LCM of the three frequencies. LCM(200 MHz, 120 MHz, 25 MHz) = 600 MHz. The LCM  
frequency is the lowest frequency for which all of the target output frequencies are integer divisors of the  
LCM. Note: if there is one frequency which causes the LCM to be very large, greater than 3 GHz for  
example, determine if there is a single frequency requirement which causes this. It may be possible to select  
the VCXO/crystal frequency to satisfy this frequency requirement through OSCout or CLKout6/7/8/9 driven by  
OSCin. In this way it is possible to get non-integer related frequencies at the outputs.  
Second, since the LCM is not in a VCO frequency range supported by the LMK0480x family, multiply the  
LCM frequency by an integer which causes it to fall into a valid VCO frequency range of an LMK0480x  
device. In this case 600 MHz * 5 = 3000 MHz which is valid for the LMK04808.  
Third, continuing the example by using a VCO frequency of 3000 MHz and the LMK04808, the CLKout  
dividers can be calculated by simply dividing the VCO frequency by the output frequency. To output 200 MHz,  
120 MHz, and 25 MHz the output dividers will be 12, 20, and 96 respectively.  
3000 MHz / 200 MHz = 15  
3000 MHz / 120 MHz = 25  
3000 MHz / 25 MHz = 120  
Fourth, PLL2 must be locked to its input reference. Refer to PLL Programming for more information on this  
topic. By programming the clock output dividers and the PLL2 dividers the VCO can lock to the frequency of  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
103  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Application Information (continued)  
3000 MHz and the clock outputs dividers will each divide the VCO frequency down to the target output  
frequencies of 200 MHz, 120 MHz, and 25 MHz.  
Refer to Application Note AN-1865, Frequency Synthesis and Planning for PLL Architectures (SNAA061) for  
more information on this topic and LCM calculations.  
9.1.5 PLL Programming  
To lock a PLL the divided reference and divided feedback from VCO or VCXO must result in the same phase  
detector frequency. The tables below illustrate how the divides are structured for the reference path (R) and  
feedback path (N) depending on the MODE of the device.  
Table 113. PLL1 Phase Detector Frequency — Reference Path (R)  
MODE  
PLL1 PDF (R) =  
All  
CLKinX Frequency / (CLKinX_PreR_DIV * PLL1_R)  
Table 114. PLL1 Phase Detector Frequency — Feedback Path (N)  
MODE  
VCO_MUX  
OSCout0  
Bypass  
Divided  
PLL1 PDF (N) =  
VCXO Frequency / PLL1_N  
Dual PLL, Internal VCO  
VCXO Frequency / (OSCin_DIV * PLL1_N)  
VCO Frequency / (CLKoutX_Y_DIV * PLL1_N)  
(1)  
Bypass  
Divided  
Dual PLL, Internal VCO, 0-Delay  
Dual PLL, External VCO, 0-Delay  
(1)  
VCO Frequency / (VCO_DIV * CLKoutX_Y_DIV * PLL1_N)  
(1)  
VCO Frequency / (CLKoutX_Y_DIV * PLL1_N)  
(1) The actual CLKoutX_Y_DIV used is selected by the feedback mux. See EN_FEEDBACK_MUX.  
Table 115. PLL2 Phase Detector Frequency — Reference Path (R)  
EN_PLL2_REF_2X  
Disabled  
PLL2 PDF (R) =  
OSCin Frequency / PLL2_R(1)(2)  
Enabled  
OSCin Frequency * 2 / PLL2_R(1)(2)  
(1) For applications in which the OSCin frequency and PLL2 phase detector frequency are equal, the best PLL2 in-band noise can be  
achieved when the doubler is enabled (EN_PLL2_REF_2X = 1) and the PLL2 R divide value is 2. Do not use doubler disabled  
(EN_PLL2_REF_2X = 0) and PLL2 R divide value of 1.  
(2) See PLL2 Frequency Doubler  
Table 116. PLL2 Phase Detector Frequency — Feedback Path (N)  
MODE  
VCO_MUX  
PLL2 PDF (N) =  
Dual PLL, Internal VCO  
Dual PLL, Internal VCO, 0-Delay  
Single PLL, Internal VCO  
Dual PLL, Internal VCO  
VCO  
VCO Frequency / (PLL2_P * PLL2_N)  
Dual PLL, Internal VCO, 0-Delay  
Single PLL, Internal VCO  
Dual PLL, External VCO  
Dual PLL External VCO, 0-Delay  
Single PLL, External VCO  
VCO Divider VCO Frequency / (VCO_DIV * PLL2_P * PLL2_N)  
VCO Frequency / (PLL2_P * PLL2_N)  
VCO  
VCO Frequency / (CLKoutX_Y_DIV * PLL2_N)  
Single PLL, Internal VCO, 0-Delay  
VCO Divider VCO Frequency / (VCO_DIV * CLKoutX_Y_DIV * PLL2_N)  
104  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Table 117. PLL2 Phase Detector Frequency — Feedback Path (N) during VCO Frequency Calibration  
MODE  
VCO_MUX  
VCO  
PLL2 PDF (N_CAL) =  
VCO Frequency / (PLL2_P * PLL2_N_CAL)  
VCO Frequency / (VCO_DIV * PLL2_P * PLL2_N_CAL)  
All Internal VCO  
Modes  
VCO Divider  
9.1.5.1 Example PLL2 N Divider Programming  
To program PLL2 to lock an LMK04808 using Dual PLL mode to a VCO frequency of 3000 MHz using a 40 MHz  
VCXO reference, first determine the total PLL2 N divide value. This is VCO Frequency / PLL2 phase detector  
frequency. This example assumes the PLL2 reference frequency doubler is enabled and a PLL2 R divide value  
of 2 (see Note 1 in Table 115) which results in PLL2 phase detector frequency the same as PLL2 reference  
frequency (40 MHz). 3000 MHz / 40 MHz = 75, so the total PLL2 N divide value is 75.  
The dividers in the PLL2 N feedback path for Dual PLL mode include PLL2_P and PLL2_N. PLL2_P can be  
programmed from 2 to 8 including both even and odd values. PLL2_N can be programmed from 1 to 263,143  
including both even and odd values. Since the total PLL2 N divide value of 75 contains the factors 3, 5, and 5, it  
would be allowable to program PLL2_P to 3 or 5. It is simplest to use the smallest divide, so PLL2_P = 3, and  
PLL2_N = 25 which results in a Total PLL2 N = 75.  
For this example and in most cases, PLL2_N_CAL will have the same value as PLL2_N. However when using  
Single PLL mode with 0-delay, the values will differ. When using an external VCO, PLL2_N_CAL value is  
unused.  
To lock a PLL the divided reference and divided feedback from VCO or VCXO must result in the same phase  
detector frequency. The following tables illustrate how the divides are structured for the reference path (R) and  
feedback path (N) depending on the MODE of the device.  
Table 118. PLL1 Phase Detector Frequency — Reference Path (R)  
MODE  
(R) PLL1 PDF =  
All  
CLKinX Frequency / CLKinX_PreR_DIV / PLL1_R  
Table 119. PLL1 Phase Detector Frequency — Feedback Path (N)  
MODE  
VCO_MUX  
OSCout0  
Bypass  
Divided  
PLL1 PDF (N) =  
VCXO Frequency / PLL1_N  
Internal VCO Dual PLL  
VCXO Frequency / OSCin_DIV / PLL1_N  
VCO Frequency / CLKoutX_Y_DIV / PLL1_N  
(1)  
Bypass  
Divided  
Internal VCO /w 0-delay  
(1)  
VCO Frequency / VCO_DIV / CLKoutX_Y_DIV / PLL1_N  
(1) The actual CLKoutX_Y_DIV used is selected by FEEDBACK_MUX.  
Table 120. PLL2 Phase Detector Frequency — Reference Path (R)  
EN_PLL2_REF_2X  
PLL2 PDF (R) =  
Disabled  
Enabled  
OSCin Frequency / PLL2_R(1)  
OSCin Frequency * 2 / PLL2_R(1)  
(1) For applications in which the OSCin frequency and PLL2 phase detector frequency are equal, the best PLL2 in-band noise can be  
achieved when the doubler is enabled (EN_PLL2_REF_2X = 1) and the PLL2 R divide value is 2. Do not use doubler disabled  
(EN_PLL2_REF_2X = 0) and PLL2 R divide value of 1.  
Table 121. PLL2 Phase Detector Frequency — Feedback Path (N)  
MODE  
Dual PLL  
VCO_MUX  
PLL2 PDF (N) =  
Dual PLL /w 0-delay  
Single PLL  
VCO  
VCO Frequency / PLL2_P / PLL2_N  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
105  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Table 121. PLL2 Phase Detector Frequency — Feedback Path (N) (continued)  
MODE  
Dual PLL  
VCO_MUX  
PLL2 PDF (N) =  
Dual PLL /w 0-delay  
Single PLL  
VCO Divider VCO Frequency / VCO_DIV / PLL2_P / PLL2_N  
Dual PLL External VCO  
Dual PLL External VCO /w 0-delay  
VCO Frequency / VCO_DIV / PLL2_P / PLL2_N  
VCO Frequency / CLKoutX_Y_DIV / PLL2_N  
VCO  
Single PLL /w 0-delay  
VCO Divider VCO Frequency / VCO_DIV / CLKoutX_Y_DIV / PLL2_N  
Table 122. PLL2 Phase Detector Frequency — Feedback Path (N) during VCO Frequency Calibration  
MODE  
VCO_MUX  
PLL2 PDF (N_CAL) =  
VCO Frequency / PLL2_P / PLL2_N_CAL  
VCO  
All Internal VCO Modes  
VCO Divider VCO Frequency / VCO_DIV / PLL2_P / PLL2_N_CAL  
9.1.5.1.1 Example PLL2 N Divider Programming  
To program PLL2 to lock an LMK04808 using Dual PLL mode to a VCO frequency of 3000 MHz using a 40-MHz  
VCXO reference, first determine the total PLL2 N divide value. This is VCO Frequency / PLL2 phase detector  
frequency. This example assumes a PLL2 R divide value of 1 which results in PLL2 phase detector frequency  
the same as PLL2 reference frequency (40 MHz). 3000 MHz / 40 MHz = 75, so the total PLL2 N divide value is  
75.  
The dividers in the PLL2 N feedback path for Dual PLL mode include PLL2_P and PLL2_N. PLL2_P can be  
programmed from 2 to 8, including both even and odd values. PLL2_N can be programmed from 1 to 263,143,  
including both even and odd values. Since the total PLL2 N divide value of 75 contains the factors 3, 5, and 5, it  
would be allowable to program PLL2_P to 3 or 5. It is simplest to use the smallest divide, so PLL2_P = 3, and  
PLL2_N = 25 which results in a Total PLL2 N = 75.  
For this example and in most cases, PLL2_N_CAL will have the same value as PLL2_N. However when using  
Single PLL mode with 0-delay, the values will differ. When using an external VCO, PLL2_N_CAL value is  
unused.  
9.1.6 Digital Lock Detect Frequency Accuracy  
The digital lock detect circuit is used to determine PLL1 locked, PLL2 locked, and holdover exit events. A window  
size and lock count register are programmed to set a ppm frequency accuracy of reference to feedback signals  
of the PLL for each event to occur. When a PLL digital lock event occurs the PLL's digital lock detect is asserted  
true. When the holdover exit event occurs, the device will exit holdover mode.  
Table 123. Digital Lock Detect Frequency Accuracy Table  
EVENT  
PLL  
PLL1  
PLL2  
PLL1  
WINDOW SIZE  
PLL1_WND_SIZE  
PLL2_WND_SIZE  
PLL1_WND_SIZE  
LOCK COUNT  
PLL1_DLD_CNT  
PLL1 Locked  
PLL2 Locked  
Holdover exit  
PLL2_DLD_CNT  
HOLDOVER_DLD_CNT  
For a digital lock detect event to occur there must be a “lock count” number of phase detector cycles of PLLX  
during which the time/phase error of the PLLX_R reference and PLLX_N feedback signal edges are within the  
user programmable "window size." Since there must be at least "lock count" phase detector events before a lock  
event occurs, a minimum digital lock event time can be calculated as "lock count" / fPDX where X = 1 for PLL1 or  
2 for PLL2.  
By using Equation 5, values for a "lock count" and "window size" can be chosen to set the frequency accuracy  
required by the system in ppm before the digital lock detect event occurs:  
2e6 × PLLX_WND_SIZE × fPDX  
ppm =  
PLLX_DLD_CNT  
(5)  
106  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
The effect of the "lock count" value is that it shortens the effective lock window size by dividing the "window size"  
by "lock count".  
If at any time the PLLX_R reference and PLLX_N feedback signals are outside the time window set by "window  
size", then the “lock count” value is reset to 0.  
9.1.6.1 Minimum Digital Lock Detect Time Calculation Example  
Given a PLL2 phase detector frequency of 40 MHz and PLL2_DLD_CNT value of 10,000, the minimum digital  
lock detect time of PLL2 will be 10,000 / 40 MHz = 250 μs.  
9.1.7 Calculating Dynamic Digital Delay Values for any Divide  
This section explains how to calculate the dynamic digital delay for any divide value.  
Dynamic digital delay allows the time offset between two or more clock outputs to be adjusted with no or minimal  
interruption of clock outputs. Since the clock outputs are operating at a known frequency, the time offset can also  
be expressed as a phase shift. When dynamically adjusting the digital delay of clock outputs with different  
frequencies the phase shift should be expressed in terms of the higher frequency clock. The step size of the  
smallest time adjustment possible is equal to half the period of the Clock Distribution Path, which is the VCO  
frequency (Equation 3) or the VCO frequency divided by the VCO divider (Equation 4) if not bypassed. The  
smallest degree phase adjustment with respect to a clock frequency will be 360 * the smallest time adjustment *  
the clock frequency. The total number of phase offsets that the LMK0480x family is able to achieve using  
dynamic digital delay is equal 1 / (higher clock frequency * the smallest phase adjustment).  
Equation 6 calculates the digital delay value that must be programmed for a synchronizing clock to achieve a 0  
time/phase offset from the qualifying clock. Once this digital delay value is known, it is possible to calculate the  
digital delay value for any phase offset. The qualifying clock for dynamic digital delay is selected by the  
FEEDBACK_MUX. When dynamic digital delay is engaged with same clock output used for the qualifying clock  
and the new synchronized clock, it is termed relative dynamic digital delay since causing another SYNC event  
with the same digital delay value will offset the clock by the same phase once again. The important part of  
relative dynamic digital delay is that the CLKoutX_Y_HS must be programmed correctly when the SYNC event  
occurs (Table 6). This can result in needing to program the device twice. Once to set the new CLKoutX_Y_DDLY  
with CLKoutX_Y_HS as required for the SYNC event, and again to set the CLKoutX_Y_HS to its desired value.  
Digital delay values are programmed using the CLKoutX_Y_DDLY and CLKoutX_Y_HS registers as shown in  
Equation 7. For example, to achieve a digital delay of 13.5, program CLKoutX_Y_DDLY = 14 and  
CLKoutX_Y_HS = 1.  
§
¨
·
§
¨
·
¹
ª
«
º
»
16  
0 digital delay =  
u CLKoutX_Y_DIV  
+ 0.5  
¸- 11.5  
¸
CLKoutX_Y_DIV  
«
»
©
©
¹
(6)  
Equation 6 uses the ceiling operator. To find the ceiling of a fractional number round up. An integer remains the  
same value.  
Digital delay = CLKoutX_Y_DDLY - (0.5 * CLKoutX_Y_HS)  
(7)  
Note: since the digital delay value for 0 time/phase offset is a function of the qualifying clock's divide value, the  
resulting digital delay value can be used for any clock output operating at any frequency to achieve a 0  
time/phase offset from the qualifying clock. Therefore the calculated time shift table will also be the same as in  
Table 124.  
9.1.7.1 Example  
Consider a system with:  
A VCO frequency of 2000 MHz.  
The VCO divider is bypassed, therefore the clock distribution path frequency is 2000 MHz.  
CLKout0_1_DIV = 10 resulting in a 200 MHz frequency on CLKout0.  
CLKout2_3_DIV = 20 resulting in a 100 MHz frequency on CLKout2.  
For this system the minimum time adjustment is 0.25 ns, which is 0.5 / (2000 MHz). Since the higher frequency  
is 200 MHz, phase adjustments will be calculated with respect to the 200 MHz frequency. The 0.25 ns minimum  
time adjustment results in a minimum phase adjustment of 18 degrees, which is 360 degrees / 200 MHz * 0.25  
ns.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
107  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
To calculate the digital delay value to achieve a 0 time/phase shift of CLKout2 when CLKout0 is the qualifying  
clock. Solve Equation 6 using the divide value of 10. To solve the equation 16/10 = 1.6, the ceiling of 1.6 is 2.  
Then to finish solving the equation solve (2 + 0.5) * 10 - 11.5 = 13.5. A digital delay value of 13.5 is programmed  
by setting CLKout2_3_DDLY = 14 and CLKout2_3_HS = 1.  
To calculate the digital delay value to achieve a 0 time/phase shift of CLKout0 when CLKout2 is the qualifying  
clock, solve Equation 6 using the divide value of CLKout2, which is 20. This results in a digital delay of 18.5  
which is programmed as CLKout0_1_DDLY = 19 and CLKout0_1_HS = 1.  
Once the 0 time/phase shift digital delay programming value is known a table can be constructed with the digital  
delay value to be programmed for any time/phase offset by decrementing or incrementing the digital delay value  
by 0.5 for the minimum time/phase adjustment.  
A complete filled out table for use of CLKout0 as the qualifying clock is shown in Table 124. It was created by  
entering a digital delay of 13.5 for 0 degree phase shift, then decrementing the digital delay down to the minimum  
value of 4.5. Since this did not result in all the possible phase shifts, the digital delay was then incremented from  
13.5 to 14.0 to complete all possible phase shifts.  
Table 124. Example Digital Delay Calculation  
CALCULATED TIME SHIFT  
(ns)  
RELATIVE TIME SHIFT  
to 200 MHz (ns)  
PHASE SHIFT  
of 200 MHz (Degrees)  
DIGITAL DELAY  
4.5  
5
-4.5  
-4.25  
-4.0  
0.5  
0.75  
1.0  
36  
54  
5.5  
6
72  
-3.75  
-3.5  
1.25  
1.5  
90  
6.5  
7
108  
126  
144  
162  
180  
198  
216  
234  
252  
270  
288  
306  
324  
342  
0
-3.25  
-3.0  
1.75  
2.0  
7.5  
8
-2.75  
-2.5  
2.25  
2.5  
8.5  
9
-2.25  
-2.0  
2.75  
3.0  
9.5  
10  
-1.75  
-1.5  
3.25  
3.5  
10.5  
11  
-1.25  
-1.0  
3.75  
4.0  
11.5  
12  
-0.75  
-0.5  
4.25  
4.5  
12.5  
13  
-0.25  
0
4.75  
0
13.5  
14  
0.25  
0.5  
0.25  
0.5  
18  
14.5  
36  
Observe that the digital delay value of 4.5 and 14.5 will achieve the same relative time shift/phase delay.  
However programming a digital delay of 14.5 will result in a clock off time for the synchronizing clock to achieve  
the same phase time shift/phase delay.  
Digital delay value is programmed as CLKoutX_Y_DDLY - (0.5 * CLKoutX_Y_HS). So to achieve a digital delay  
of 13.5, program CLKoutX_Y_DDLY = 14 and CLKoutX_Y_HS = 1. To achieve a digital delay of 14, program  
CLKoutX_Y_DDLY = 14 and CLKoutX_Y_HS = 0.  
108  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
9.1.8 Optional Crystal Oscillator Implementation (OSCin/OSCin*)  
The LMK0480x family features supporting circuitry for a discretely implemented oscillator driving the OSCin port  
pins. Figure 35 illustrates a reference design circuit for a crystal oscillator:  
OSCin*  
C
C1  
= 2.2 nF  
C
opt  
R1 = 4.7k  
SMV1249-074LF  
R3 = 10k  
LMK0480x  
XTAL  
1 nF  
R2 = 4.7k  
C
C2  
= 2.2 nF  
OSCin  
C
opt  
PLL1 Loop Filter  
Figure 35. Reference Design Circuit for Crystal Oscillator Option  
This circuit topology represents a parallel resonant mode oscillator design. When selecting a crystal for parallel  
resonance, the total load capacitance, CL, must be specified. The load capacitance is the sum of the tuning  
capacitance (CTUNE), the capacitance seen looking into the OSCin port (CIN), and stray capacitance due to PCB  
parasitics (CSTRAY), and is given by Equation 8.  
CSTRAY  
CL = CTUNE + CIN  
+
2
(8)  
CTUNE is provided by the varactor diode shown in Figure 35, Skyworks model SMV1249-074LF. A dual diode  
package with common cathode provides the variable capacitance for tuning. The single diode capacitance  
ranges from approximately 31 pF at 0.3 V to 3.4 pF at 3 V. The capacitance range of the dual package (anode to  
anode) is approximately 15.5 pF at 3 V to 1.7 pF at 0.3 V. The desired value of VTUNE applied to the diode should  
be VCC/2, or 1.65 V for VCC = 3.3 V. The typical performance curve from the data sheet for the SMV1249-074LF  
indicates that the capacitance at this voltage is approximately 6 pF (12 pF / 2).  
The nominal input capacitance (CIN) of the LMK0480x family OSCin pins is 6 pF. The stray capacitance (CSTRAY  
)
of the PCB should be minimized by arranging the oscillator circuit layout to achieve trace lengths as short as  
possible and as narrow as possible trace width (50 Ω characteristic impedance is not required).  
As an example, assume that CSTRAY is 4 pF. The total load capacitance is nominally:  
4
2
= 14 pF  
CL = 6 + 6 +  
(9)  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
109  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Consequently the load capacitance specification for the crystal in this case should be nominally 14 pF.  
The 2.2-nF capacitors shown in the circuit are coupling capacitors that block the DC tuning voltage applied by  
the 4.7-kand 10-kresistors. The value of these coupling capacitors should be large, relative to the value of  
CTUNE (CC1 = CC2 >> CTUNE), so that CTUNE becomes the dominant capacitance.  
For a specific value of CL, the corresponding resonant frequency (FL) of the parallel resonant mode circuit is:  
1
+ 1  
C1  
2(C0 + CL1  
C0  
CL  
C1  
+ 1  
= FS À  
§
·
¸
¹
FL = FS  
À
)
+
2 ¨C  
1
©
where  
FS = Series resonant frequency  
C1 = Motional capacitance of the crystal  
CL = Load capacitance  
C0 = Shunt capacitance of the crystal, specified on the crystal datasheet  
(10)  
(11)  
The normalized tuning range of the circuit is closely approximated by:  
1
1
-
FCL1 - FCL2  
C1  
2
1
2
1
1
'F  
F
C0 CL1  
+
C0 CL2  
+
À
-
§
¨
©
· §  
·
¸
¹
À
=
=
=
(C0 + CL1  
)
(C0 + CL2)  
FFCL1  
¸ ¨C  
C1  
C1  
C1  
1
¹ ©  
CL1, CL2 = The endpoints of the circuit’s load capacitance range, assuming a variable capacitance element is one  
component of the load. FCL1, FCL2 = parallel resonant frequencies at the extremes of the circuit’s load  
capacitance range.  
A common range for the pullability ratio, C0/C1, is 250 to 280. The ratio of the load capacitance to the shunt  
capacitance is ~(n * 1000), n < 10. Hence, picking a crystal with a smaller pullability ratio supports a wider tuning  
range because this allows the scale factors related to the load capacitance to dominate.  
Examples of the phase noise and jitter performance of the LMK04808 with a crystal oscillator are shown in  
Table 125. This table illustrates the clock output phase noise when a 20.48-MHz crystal is paired with PLL1.  
Performance of other LMK0480x devices will be similar.  
110  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Table 125. Example RMS Jitter and Clock Output Phase Noise for LMK04808  
(1)  
with a 20.48 MHz Crystal Driving OSCin (T = 25 °C, VCC = 3.3 V)  
PLL2 PDF = 20.48 MHz  
(EN_PLL2_REF2X = 0,  
XTAL_LVL = 3)  
PLL2 PDF = 40.96 MHz  
(EN_PLL2_REF2X = 1, XTAL_LVL = 3)  
INTEGRATION  
BANDWIDTH  
CLOCK OUTPUT TYPE  
fCLK = 245.76 MHz  
fCLK = 122.88 MHz  
fCLK = 245.76 MHz  
RMS JITTER (fs rms)  
LVCMOS  
LVDS  
374  
419  
460  
226  
231  
226  
412  
421  
448  
195  
205  
191  
382  
372  
440  
190  
194  
188  
100 Hz – 20 MHz  
LVPECL 1.6 Vpp  
LVCMOS  
10 kHz – 20 MHz  
LVDS  
LVPECL 1.6 Vpp  
PHASE NOISE (dBc/Hz)  
PLL2 PDF = 20.48 MHz  
(EN_PLL2_REF2X = 0,  
XTAL_LVL = 3)  
PLL2 PDF = 40.96 MHz  
(EN_PLL2_REF2X = 1, XTAL_LVL = 3)  
Offset  
Clock Output Type  
fCLK = 245.76 MHz  
-87  
fCLK = 122.88 MHz  
-93  
fCLK = 245.76 MHz  
-87  
LVCMOS  
LVDS  
100 Hz  
1 kHz  
-86  
-91  
-86  
LVPECL 1.6 Vpp  
LVCMOS  
-86  
-92  
-85  
-115  
-121  
-115  
LVDS  
-115  
-123  
-116  
LVPECL 1.6 Vpp  
LVCMOS  
-114  
-122  
-116  
-117  
-128  
-122  
10 kHz  
100 kHz  
1 MHz  
LVDS  
-117  
-128  
-122  
LVPECL 1.6 Vpp  
LVCMOS  
-117  
-128  
-122  
-130  
-135  
-129  
LVDS  
-130  
-135  
-129  
LVPECL 1.6 Vpp  
LVCMOS  
-129  
-135  
-129  
-150  
-154  
-148  
LVDS  
-149  
-153  
-148  
LVPECL 1.6 Vpp  
LVCMOS  
-150  
-154  
-148  
-159  
-162  
-159  
40 MHz  
LVDS  
-157  
-159  
-157  
LVPECL 1.6 Vpp  
-159  
-161  
-159  
(1) Performance data and crystal specifications contained in this section are based on Vectron model VXB1-1150-20M480, 20.48 MHz.  
PLL1 has a narrow loop bandwidth, PLL2 loop parameters are: C1 = 150 pF, C2 = 120 nF, R2 = 470 , Charge Pump current = 3.2 mA,  
Phase detector frequency = 20.48 MHz or 40.96 MHz, VCO frequency = 2949.12 MHz. Loop filter was optimized for 40.96 MHz phase  
detector performance.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
111  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Example crystal specifications are presented in Table 126.  
Table 126. Example Crystal Specifications  
PARAMETER  
VALUE  
Nominal Frequency (MHz)  
20.48  
Frequency Stability, T = 25 °C  
Operating temperature range  
Frequency Stability, -40 °C to +85 °C  
Load Capacitance  
± 10 ppm  
-40 °C to +85 °C  
± 15 ppm  
14 pF  
Shunt Capacitance (C0)  
Motional Capacitance (C1)  
Equivalent Series Resistance  
Drive level  
5 pF Maximum  
20 fF ± 30%  
25 Ω Maximum  
2 mWatts Maximum  
225 typical, 250 Maximum  
C0/C1 ratio  
See Figure 36 for a representative tuning curve.  
180  
140  
100  
60  
20  
-20  
-60  
-100  
-140  
-180  
0.0 0.4 0.8 1.2 1.6 2.0 2.4 2.8 3.2  
V
(V)  
TUNE  
Figure 36. Example Tuning Curve, 20.48 MHz Crystal  
The tuning curve achieved in the user's application may differ from the curve shown above due to differences in  
PCB layout and component selection.  
This data is measured on the bench with the crystal integrated with the LMK0480x family. Using a voltmeter to  
monitor the VTUNE node for the crystal, the PLL1 reference clock input frequency is swept in frequency and the  
resulting tuning voltage generated by PLL1 is measured at each frequency. At each value of the reference clock  
frequency, the lock state of PLL1 should be monitored to ensure that the tuning voltage applied to the crystal is  
valid.  
The curve shows over the tuning voltage range of 0.3 VDC to 3.0 VDC, the frequency range is -140 to +91 ppm;  
or equivalently, a tuning range of -2850 Hz to +1850 Hz. The measured tuning voltage at the nominal crystal  
frequency (20.48 MHz) is 1.7 V. Using the diode data sheet tuning characteristics, this voltage results in a tuning  
capacitance of approximately 6.5 pF.  
112  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
The tuning curve data can be used to calculate the gain of the oscillator (KVCO). The data used in the calculations  
is taken from the most linear portion of the curve, a region centered on the crossover point at the nominal  
frequency (20.48 MHz). For a well designed circuit, this is the most likely operating range. In this case, the tuning  
range used for the calculations is ± 1000 Hz (± 0.001 MHz), or ± 81.4 ppm. The simplest method is to calculate  
the ratio:  
'F2 - 'F1  
§
= ¨V  
©
·
'F  
'V  
MHz  
V
¸,  
¹
KVCO  
=
TUNE2 - VTUNE1  
(12)  
(13)  
ΔF2 and ΔF1 are in units of MHz. Using data from the curve this becomes:  
0.001 - (-0.001)  
2.03 - 0.814  
MHz  
V
= 0.00164  
A second method uses the tuning data in units of ppm:  
FNOM À ('ppm2 - 'ppm1)  
KVCO  
=
'V À 106  
(14)  
(15)  
FNOM is the nominal frequency of the crystal and is in units of MHz. Using the data, this becomes:  
12.288 À (81.4 - (-81.4))  
MHz  
= 0.00164,  
(2.03 - 0.814) À 106  
V
In order to ensure startup of the oscillator circuit, the equivalent series resistance (ESR) of the selected crystal  
should conform to the specifications listed in the table of Electrical Characteristics.  
It is also important to select a crystal with adequate power dissipation capability, or drive level. If the drive level  
supplied by the oscillator exceeds the maximum specified by the crystal manufacturer, the crystal will undergo  
excessive aging and possibly become damaged. Drive level is directly proportional to resonant frequency,  
capacitive load seen by the crystal, voltage and equivalent series resistance (ESR).  
For more complete coverage of crystal oscillator design, see:  
http://www.ti.com/lsds/ti/analog/clocksandtimers/tools.page or Application Note AN-1939, Crystal Based Oscillator  
Design with the LMK04000 Family (SNAA065).  
9.1.9 Application Curves  
See Figure 36 for a representative tuning curve.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
113  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
9.2 Typical Applications  
Normal use case of the LMK0480x device is as a dual loop jitter cleaner. This section will discuss a design  
example to illustrate the various functional aspects of the LMK0480x device.  
PLL1  
PLL2  
External  
Loop Filter  
OSCoutX  
External VCXO  
or Tunable  
Crystal  
OSCoutX*  
2 outputs  
CLKinX  
CLKinX*  
R
N
Phase  
Detector  
PLL1  
CPout2  
External  
Loop Filter  
2 inputs  
CLKoutY  
CLKoutY*  
R
N
Phase  
Detector  
PLL2  
Divider  
Digital Delay  
Analog Delay  
Partially  
Integrated  
Loop Filter  
Input  
Buffer  
CLKoutX  
CLKoutX*  
Internal  
VCO  
12 outputs  
6 blocks  
LMK0480x  
Figure 37. Simplified Functional Block Diagram for Dual Loop Mode  
9.2.1 Design Requirements  
Given a remote radio head (RRU) type application which needs to clock some ADCs, DACs, FPGA, SERDES,  
and an LO. The input clock will be a recovered clock which needs jitter cleaning. The FPGA clock should have a  
clock output on power up. A summary of clock input and output requirements are as follows:  
Clock Input:  
30.72 MHz recovered clock.  
Clock Outputs:  
2x 245.76 MHz clock for ADC, LVPECL  
4x 983.04 MHz clock for DAC, LVPECL  
1x 122.88 MHz clock for FPGA, LVPECL. POR clock  
1x 122.88 MHz clock for SERDES, LVPECL  
2x 122.88 MHz clock for LO, LVCMOS  
It is also desirable to have the holdover feature engage if the recovered clock reference is ever lost. The  
following information reviews the steps to produce this design.  
9.2.2 Detailed Design Procedure  
Design of all aspects of the LMK0480x are quite involved and software has been written to assist in part  
selection, part programming, loop filter design, and simulation. This design procedure will give a quick outline of  
the process.  
Note that this information is current as of the date of the release of this datasheet. Design tools receive  
continuous improvements to add features and improve model accuracy. Refer to software instructions or training  
for latest features.  
1. Device Selection  
the key to device selection is required VCO frequency given required output frequencies. The device  
must be able to produce the VCO frequency that can be divided down to required output frequencies.  
The software design tools will take inot account VCO frequency range for specific devices based on the  
application's required output frequencies. Using an external VCO provides increased flexibility regarding  
valid designs.  
To understand the process better, refer to Frequency Planning with the LMK0480x Family for more detail  
on calculating valid VCO frequency when using integer dividers using the least common multiple (LCM) of  
the output frequencies.  
114  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Typical Applications (continued)  
2. Device Configuration  
There are many possible permutations of dividers and other registers to get same input and output  
frequencies from a device. However there are some optimizations and trade-offs to be considered.  
If more than one divider is in series, for instance VCO divider to CLKout divider, or VCO divider to PLL  
prescaler to PLL N. It is possible although not assured that some crosstalk/mixing could be created  
when using some divides.  
The design software normally attempts to maximize phase detector frequency, use smallest dividers, and  
maximizes PLL charge pump current.  
When an external VCXO or crystal is used for jitter cleaning, the design software will choose the  
maximum frequency value, depending on design software options, this max frequency may be limited to  
standard value VCXOs/Crystals. Note, depending on application, different frequency VCXOs may be  
chosen to generate some of the required output frequencies.  
Refer to PLL Programming for divider equations need to ensure PLL is locked. The design software is  
able to configure the device for most cases, but at this time for advanced features like 0-delay, the  
user must take care to ensure proper PLL programming.  
These guidelines may be followed when configuring PLL related dividers or other related registers:  
For lowest possible in-band PLL flat noise, maximize phase detector frequency to minimize N divide  
value.  
For lowest possible in-band PLL flat noise, maximize charge pump current. The highest value charge  
pump currents often have similar performance due to diminishing returns.  
To reduce loop filter component sizes, increase N value and/or reduce charge pump current.  
Large capacitors help reduce phase detector spurs at phase detector frequency caused by external  
VCOs/VCXOs with low input impedance.  
As rule of thumb, keeping the phase detector frequency approximately between 10 * PLL loop  
bandwidth and 100 * PLL loop bandwidth. A phase detector frequency less than 5 * PLL bandwidth  
may be unstable and a phase detector frequency > 100 * loop bandwidth may experience increased  
lock time due to cycle slipping.  
3. PLL Loop Filter Design  
It is recommended to use Clock Design Tool or Clock Architect to design your loop filter.  
Best loop filter design and simulation can be achieved when:  
Custom reference and VCXO phase noise profiles are loaded into the software.  
VCO gain of the external VCXO or possible external VCO device are entered.  
The Clock Design Tool will return solutions with high reference/phase detector frequencies by default. In  
the Clock Design Tool the user may increase the reference divider to reduce the frequency if desired.  
Due to the narrow loop bandwidth used on PLL1, it is common to lower the phase detector frequency on  
PLL1 to reduce component size.  
While designing loop filter, adjusting the charge pump current or N value can help with loop filter  
component selection. Lower charge pump currents and larger N values result in smaller component  
values but may increase impacts of leakage and reduce PLL phase noise performance.  
More detailed understanding of loop filter design can found in Dean Banerjee's PLL Performance,  
Simulation, and Design (www.ti.com/tool/pll_book).  
4. Clock Output Assignment  
At this time the design software does not take into account frequency assignment to specific outputs  
except to ensure that the output frequencies can be achieved. It is best to consider proximity of each  
clock output to each other and other PLL circuitry when choosing final clock output locations. Here are  
some guidelines to help achieve best performance when assigning outputs to specific CLKout/OSCout  
pins.  
Group common frequencies together.  
PLL charge pump circuitry can cause crosstalk at charge pump frequency. Place outputs sharing  
charge pump frequency or lower priority outputs not sensitive to charge pump frequency spurs  
together.  
Muxes can create a path for noise coupling. Consider all frequencies which may have some bleed  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
115  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Typical Applications (continued)  
through from non-selected mux inputs.  
For example, LMK0480x CLKout6/7 and CLKout8/9 share a mux with OSCin.  
Some clock targets require low close-in phase noise. If possible, use a VCXO based PLL1 output for  
such a clock target. An example is a clock to a PLL reference.  
Some clock targets require excellent noise floor performance. Outputs driven by the internal VCO have  
the best noise floor performance. An example is an ADC or DAC.  
5. Other device specific configuration. For LMK0480x, consider the following:  
PLL lock time based on programming:  
In addition to the time it takes the device to lock to frequency, there is a digital filter to avoid false lock  
time detects which can also be used to ensure a specific PPM frequency accuracy. This also impacts  
the time it takes for the digital lock detect (DLD) pin to be asserted. Refer to Digital Lock Detect  
Frequency Accuracy for more information.  
Holdover configuration:  
Specific PPM frequency accuracy required to exit holdover can be programmed. Refer to Digital Lock  
Detect Frequency Accuracy for more information.  
Digital delay: phase alignment of the output clocks.  
Analog delay: another method to shift phases of clocks with finer resolution with the penalty of increase  
noise floor. Clock Design Tool can simulate analog delay impact on phase noise floor.  
Dynamic digital delay: ability to shift phase alignment of clocks with minimum disruption during operation.  
6. Device Programming  
The software tool CodeLoader for EVM programming can be used to setup the device in the desired  
configuration, then export a hex register map suitable for use in application.  
Some additional information on each part of the design procedure for the RRU example is below.  
9.2.2.1 Device Selection  
Use the WEBENCH Clock Architect Tool or Clock Design Tool. Enter the required frequencies and formats into  
the tool. To use this device, find a solution using the LMK04808B.  
9.2.2.1.1 Clock Architect  
When viewing resulting solutions, it is possible to narrow the parts used in the solution by setting a filter.  
Under advanced tab, filtering of specific parts can be done using regular expressions in the Part Filter box.  
"LMK04808B" will filter for only the LMK04808B devices (without quotes).  
9.2.2.1.2 Clock Design Tool  
In wizard-mode, select Dual Loop PLL to find the LMK04808B device. If a high frequency and clean reference is  
available, Although dual loop mode is selected as a customer requirement, it is not required to use dual loop;  
PLL1 can be powered down and input is then provided via the OSCin port. When simulating single loop  
solutions, set PLL1 loop filter block to "0 Hz LBW" and use VCXO as the reference block.  
9.2.2.1.3 Calculation Using LCM  
In this example, the LCM(245.76 MHz, 983.04 MHz, 122.88 MHz) = 983.04 MHz. A valid VCO frequency for  
LMK0480x is 2949.12 MHz = 3 * 983.04 MHz. Therefore the LMK0480B may be used to produce these output  
frequencies.  
116  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Typical Applications (continued)  
9.2.2.2 Device Configuration  
The tools automatically configure the simulation to meet the input and output frequency requirements given and  
make assumptions about other parameters to give some default simulations. The assumptions made are to  
maximize input frequencies, phase detector frequencies, and charge pump currents while minimizing VCO  
frequency and divider values.  
For this example, when using the clock design tool, the reference would have been manually entered as 30.72  
MHz according to input frequency requirements, but the tool allows VCXO1 frequency either to be set manually,  
auto-selected according to standard frequencies, or auto-selected for best frequency. With the best frequency  
option, the highest possible VCXO frequency which gives the highest possible PLL2 PDF frequency is  
recommended first. In this case: 421 + 53/175 MHz VCXO resulting in a 140 + 76/175 MHz phase detector  
frequency. This is a high phase detector frequency, but the VCXO is likely going to be a custom order. The  
select configuration page just before simulation shows before some different configurations possible with different  
VCO divider values. For example, a more common 491.52 MHz frequency provides a 122.88 MHz PDF. This is a  
more logical configuration.  
From the simulation page of clock design tool, it can be seen that the VCXO frequency of 491.52 MHz is too high  
for feedback into the PLL1_N divider. Reducing the VCXO frequency to 245.76 MHz resolves the PLL1_N divider  
max input frequency problem. The PLL2 R divider must be updated to 2 so that the VCO of PLL2 is still at  
2949.12 MHz.  
At this point the design meets all input and output frequency requirements and it is possible to design a loop filter  
for system and simulate performance on CLKouts. However, consider also the following:  
At this time the clock design tool doesn't assign outputs strategically for jitter, such as PLL1 vs PLL2. If PLL1  
output frequency is high enough, it may have improved jitter performance depending on the noise floor and  
application required integration range.  
The clock design tool does not consider power on reset clocks in the clock requirements or assignments.  
The clock design tool simplifies the LMK0480x architecture not showing the mux complexity around  
OSCout0/1 and not showing OSCout1. Simulation of OSCout0 is equivalent to OSCout1.  
The next section addresses how the user may alter the design when considering these items.  
9.2.2.2.1 PLL LO Reference  
PLL1 outputs have the best phase noise performance for LO references. As such OSCout0 can be used to  
provide the 122.88 MHz LO reference clock. To achieve this with the 245.76 MHz VCXO the OSCout_DIV can  
be set to 2 to provide 122.88 MHz at OSCout0. However in the next section it is determined that for the POR  
clock, a 122.88 MHz VCXO will be chosen which results not needing to change this parameter.  
9.2.2.2.2 POR Clock  
If OSCout1 is to be used for LVPECL POR 122.88 MHz clock, the POR value of the OSCout_DIV is 1, so a  
122.88 MHz VCXO frequency must be chosen. This may be desired anyway since the phase detector frequency  
is limited to 122.88 MHz and lower frequency VCXOs tend to cost less. With this change the OSCin frequency  
and phase detector frequency are the same, so the doubler must be enabled and the PLL2 R divider  
programmed = 2 to follow the rule stated in PLL2 Frequency Doubler. Since the clock design tool does not show  
the doubler, PLL2_R will still reflect the value 1 one for the simulation purposes.  
If LVDS was required for POR clock, a voltage divider could be used to convert from LVPECL to LVDS.  
Note: it is possible to set the PLL2 R = 0.5 to simulate the doubler in-case lower frequency VCXOs would like to  
be simulated. For example a 61.44 MHz VCXO could be used while retaining a 122.88 MHz phase detector  
frequency. However, it would reduce the LO reference frequency and POR clock frequency to 61.44 MHz.  
At this time the main design updates have been made to support the POR clock and loop filter design may begin.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
117  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Typical Applications (continued)  
9.2.2.3 PLL Loop Filter Design  
The PLL structure for the LMK0480x is illustrated in Loop Filter.  
At this time the user may choose to make adjustments to the simulation tools for more accurate simulations to  
their application. For example:  
Clock Design Tool allows loading a custom phase noise plot for any block. Typically, a custom phase noise  
plot is entered for CLKin to match the reference phase noise to the device; a phase noise plot for the VCXO  
can additionally be provided to match the performance of VCXO used. For improved accuracy in simulation  
and optimum loop filter design, be sure to load these custom noise profiles for use in application. After  
loading a phase noise plot, user should recalculate the recommended loop filter design.  
The Clock Design Tool will return solutions with high reference/phase detector frequencies by default. In the  
Clock Design Tool the user may increase the reference divider to reduce the frequency if desired. Due to the  
narrow loop bandwidth used on PLL1, it is common to reduce the phase detector frequency on PLL1 by  
increasing PLL1 R.  
For this example, for PLL1 to perform jitter cleaning and to minimize jitter from PLL2 used for frequency  
multiplication:  
PLL1: A narrow loop bandwidth PLL1 filter was design by updating the loop bandwidth to 50 Hz and phase  
margin to 50 degrees.  
PLL2:  
VCXO noise profile is measured, then loaded into VCXO block in clock design tool.  
The recommended loop filter is redesigned. Updates to the PLL1 loop filter and VCXO phase noise may  
change the loop filter recommendation.  
The next two sections will discuss PLL1 and PLL2 loop filter design specific to this example using default phase  
noise profiles.  
NOTE  
Clock Design Tool provides some recommend loop filters upon first load of the simulation.  
Anytime PLL related inputs change like an input phase noise, charge pump current,  
divider values, and so forth. it is best to re-design the PLL1 loop filter to the recommended  
design or your desired parameters. After PLL1, then update the PLL2 loop filter in the  
same way to keep the loop filters designed and optimized for the application. Since PLL1  
loop filter design may impact PLL2 loop filter design, be sure to update the designs in  
order.  
9.2.2.3.1 PLL1 Loop Filter Design  
For this example, in the clock design tool simulator click on the PLL1 loop filter design button, then update the  
loop bandwidth for 0.05 kHz and the phase margin for 50 degrees and press calculate. With the 30.72 MHz  
phase detector frequency and 1.6 mA charge pump; the designed loop filter's largest capacitor, C2, is 27 µF.  
Supposing a goal of < 10 µF; setting PLL1 R = 4 and pressing the calculate again shows that C2 is 6.8 µF.  
Suppose that a reduction to < 1 µF is desired, continuing to increase the PLL1 R to 8 resulting in a phase  
detector frequency of 3.84 MHz and reducing the charge pump current from 1.6 mA to 0.4 mA and calculating  
again shows that C2 is 820 nF. As N was increased and charge pump decreased, this final design has R2 = 12  
kΩ. The first design with low N value and high charge pump current result in R2 = 390 Ω. The impact of the  
thermal resistance is calculated in the tool. Viewing the simulation of the loop filter with the 12-kΩ resistor shows  
that the thermal noise in the loop is not impacting performance.  
It may be desired to design a 3rd order loop filter for additional attenuation input noise and spurs  
With the PLL1 loop filter design complete, PLL2's loop filter is ready to be designed.  
118  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Typical Applications (continued)  
9.2.2.3.2 PLL2 Loop Filter Design  
In the clock design tool simulator, click on the PLL2 loop filter design button, then press recommend design. For  
PLL2's loop filter maximum phase detector frequency and maximum charge pump current are typically used.  
Typically the jitter integration bandwidth includes the loop filter bandwidth for PLL2. The recommended loop filter  
by the tools are designed to minimize jitter. The integrated loop filter components are minimized with this  
recommendation as to allow maximum flexibility in achieve wide loop bandwidths for low PLL noise. With the  
recommended loop filter calculated, this loop filter is ready to be simulated.  
If using integrated components is desired, open the bode plot for the PLL2 Loop Filter, then make adjustments to  
the integrated components. The effective loop bandwidth and phase margin with these updates is calculated.  
The integrated loop filter components are good to use when attempting to eliminate some spurs since they  
provide filtering after the bond wires. The recommended procedure is to increase C3/C4 capacitance, then  
R3/R4 resistance. Large R3/R4 resistance can result in degraded VCO phase noise performance.  
9.2.2.4 Clock Output Assignment  
At this time the Clock Design Tool and Clock Architect only assign outputs to specific clock outputs numerically;  
not necessarily by optimum configuration. The user may wish to make some educated re-assignment of outputs.  
During device configuration, some output assignment was discussed since it impacted the part's configuration  
relating to loop filter design, such as:  
In this example, OSCout1 can be used to provide the power on reset (POR) start-up clock to the FPGA at  
122.88 MHz since the VCXO frequency is the required output frequency.  
Since PLL1 outputs have best in-band noise, OSCout0 is used to provide LVCMOS output to the PLL  
reference for the LO. LVCMOS (Norm/Inv) is used instead of LVCMOS (Norm/Norm) to reduce crosstalk. It is  
also possible to use CLKout6/7 or CLKout8/9 for a PLL reference being driven from the VCXO. The noise  
floor will be higher, but close-in noise is typically of more concern since noise above the loop bandwidth of the  
LO will be dominated by the VCO of the LO. See Figure 38.  
Since CLKout6/7 and CLKout8/9 have a mux allowing them to be driven by the VCXO and due there is a chance  
for some 122.88 MHz crosstalk from the VCXO. The 122.88 MHz SERDES clock will be placed on CLKout6  
since it will not be sensitive to crosstalk as it is operating at the same frequency.  
The two 245.76 MHz clocks and four 983.04 MHz clocks for the converters need to be discussed. There is some  
flexibility in assignment. For example CLKout0/1 could operate at 245.76 MHz for the ADCs and then CLKout2/3  
and CLKout4/5 could operate at 983.04 MHz for the DAC. It is also possible to consider CLKout2/3 for the ADC  
and position CLKout0/1 and CLKout10/11 for the DAC. The ADCs clock was placed as far as possible from other  
clock which could result in sub-harmonic spurs since the ADC clock is often the most sensitive.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
119  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Typical Applications (continued)  
9.2.2.5 Other Device Specific Configuration  
9.2.2.5.1 Digital Lock Detect  
Digital lock time for PLL1 will ultimately depend upon the programming of the PLL1_DLD_CNT register as  
discussed in Digital Lock Detect Frequency Accuracy. Since the PLL1 phase detector frequency in this example  
is 3.84 MHz, the lock time will = 1 / (PLL1_DLD_CNT * 3.84 MHz)  
Digital lock time for PLL1 if PLL1_DLD_CNT = 10000 is just over 2.6 ms. When using holdover, it is very  
important to program the PLL1_DLD_CNT to a value large enough to prevent false digital lock detect signals.  
If PLL1_DLD_CNT is too small, when the device exits holdover and is re-locking, the DLD will go high while the  
phase of the reference and feedback are within the specified window size because the programmed  
PLL1_DLD_CNT will be satisfied. However, if the loop has not yet settled to without the window size, when the  
phases of the reference and feedback once again exceed the window size, the DLD will return low. Provided that  
DISABLE_DLD1_DET = 0, the device once again enter holdover. Assuming that the reference clock is valid  
because holdover was just exited, the exit criteria will again be met, holdover will exit, and PLL1 will start locking.  
Unfortunately, the same sequence of events will repeat resulting in oscillation out-of and back-into holdover.  
Setting the PLL1_DLD_CNT to an appropriately large value prevents chattering of the PLL1 DLD signal and  
stable holdover operation can be achieved.  
Refer to Digital Lock Detect Frequency Accuracy for more detail on calculating exit times and how the  
PLL1_DLD_CNT and PLL1_WND_SIZE work together.  
9.2.2.5.2 Holdover  
For this example, when the recovered clock is lost, the goal is to set the VCXO to Vcc/2 until the recovered clock  
returns. Holdover Mode contains detailed information on how to program holdover.  
To achieve the above goal, fixed holdover will be used. Program:  
HOLDOVER_MODE = 2 (Holdover enabled)  
EN_TRACK = 0 (Tracking disabled)  
EN_MAN_DAC = 1 (Use manual DAC for holdover voltage value)  
MAN_DAC = 512 (Approximately Vcc/2)  
DISABLE_DLD1_DET = 0 (Use PLL1 DLD = Low to start holdover)  
9.2.2.6 Device Programming  
The CodeLoader software is used to program the LMK0480x evaluation board using the LMK04808B profile. It  
also allows the exporting of a register map which can be used to program the device to the user’s desired  
configuration.  
Once a configuration of dividers has been achieved using the Clock Design Tool to meet the requested  
input/output frequencies with the desired performance, the CodeLoader software is manually updated with this  
information to meet the required application. At this time no automatic import exists.  
120  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Typical Applications (continued)  
9.2.3 Application Curve  
-130  
-135  
-140  
-145  
-150  
-155  
-160  
-165  
VCO CLKoutX  
VCXO CLKout6/7/8/9  
VCXO OSCout0/1  
VCXO Direct  
-170  
1k  
10k  
100k  
1M  
10M  
Frequency Offset (Hz)  
D001  
Figure 38. LVPECL Phase Noise, 122.88 MHz  
Illustration of Different Performance Depending on Signal Path.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
121  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
9.3 System Examples  
9.3.1 System Level Diagram  
Figure 39 and Figure 40 show an LMK0480x family device with external circuitry for clocking and for power  
supply to serve as a guideline for good practices when designing with the LMK0480x family. Refer to Pin  
Connection Recommendations for more details on the pin connections and bypassing recommendations. Also  
refer to the evaluation board in LMK0480x Evaluation Board Instructions (SNAU076). PCB design will also play a  
role in device performance.  
Status_CLKin0  
240Ö  
Status_CLKin1  
0.1 PF  
CLKout0, 1  
CLKout0*,1*  
Status_LD  
Status_HOLDOVER  
SYNC  
2x LVPECL  
output clocks  
to DAC  
To Host  
processor  
0.1 PF  
240Ö  
240Ö  
LEuWire  
CLKuWire  
DATAuWire  
0.1 PF  
CLKout2, 3, 4, 5  
CLKout2*,3*,4*,5*  
4x LVPECL  
output clocks  
to ADC  
Recovered  
Reference  
Clock  
0.1 PF  
CLKin0  
0.1 PF  
CLKin0*  
240Ö  
50Ö  
0.1 PF  
LMK0480x  
3x LVDS clocks  
to FPGAs and  
microcontrollers  
CLKout6, 7, 8  
CLKout6*,7*,8*  
0.1 PF  
CLKin1  
CLKout 6 and 8 active at startup  
100Ö  
CLKout9  
CLKout9*  
CLKin1*  
TCXO  
0.1 PF  
0.1 PF  
LVDS Low  
Frequency  
System  
Synchronization  
Clock  
OSCin*  
CLKout10  
CLKout10*  
OSCin  
CLKout11  
CLKout11*  
0.1 PF  
R
term  
VCXO  
240Ö  
LDObyp1  
LDObyp2  
LVPECL  
OSCout clocks  
to PLL  
0.1 PF  
OSCout0, 1  
OSCout0*,1*  
0.1 PF  
references  
10 PF  
0.1 PF  
240Ö  
OSCout0 on at startup  
PLL1 Loop Filter  
Up to 14 total differential clocks  
2 clock outputs unused in above design  
PLL2 External  
Loop Filter  
Figure 39. Example Application – System Schematic Except for Power  
122  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
System Examples (continued)  
Figure 39 shows the primary reference clock input is at CLKin0/0*. A secondary reference clock is driving  
CLKin1/1*. Both clocks are depicted as AC coupled drivers. The VCXO attached to the OSCin/OSCin* port is  
configured as an AC coupled single-ended driver. Any of the input ports (CLKin0/0*, CLKin1/1*, or  
OSCin/OSCin*) may be configured as either differential or single-ended. These options are discussed later in the  
data sheet.  
See Loop Filter for more information on PLL1 and PLL2 loop filters.  
All the LVPECL clock outputs are AC coupled with 0.1 uF capacitors. The LVDS outputs are DC coupled.. Some  
clock outputs are depicted as LVPECL with 240-Ω emitter resistors and some clock outputs as LVDS. The  
appropriate output termination on each output should be implemented according to the output format to be  
programmed by the user. Later sections of this data sheet illustrate alternative methods for AC coupling, DC  
coupling and terminating the clock outputs.  
PCB design will influence crosstalk performance. Tightly coupled clock traces will have less crosstalk than  
loosely coupled clock traces. Also proximity to other clocks traces will influence crosstalk.  
PLL Supply Plane  
Vcc1  
VCO LDO  
Digital  
FB  
Vcc4  
Vcc5  
Vcc7  
Vcc9  
CLKin/OSCout1  
10 µF, 1 µF, 0.1 µF  
1 µF, 0.1 µF, 10 nF  
OSCin/OSCout0/  
PLL2 Circuitry  
PLL2 N Divider  
LDO  
LP3878-ADJ  
Vcc6  
PLL1 CP  
FB  
0.1 µF  
0.1 µF  
0.1 µF  
PLL2 CP  
FB  
0.1 µF  
FB = Ferrite bead  
Vcc8  
LMK0480x  
Clock Supply Plane  
10 µF, 1 µF, 0.1 µF  
Vcc13  
Example  
Frequency 1  
CLKout0/1  
FB  
FB  
Vcc2  
Vcc3  
CLKout2/3  
CLKout4/5  
FB  
FB  
Example  
Frequency 2  
Do not directly copy schematic for  
CLKout Vcc13/2/3/10/11/12. This  
is for example frequency plan only.  
Vcc10  
Vcc11  
Vcc12  
CLKout6/7  
CLKout8/9  
CLKout10/11  
Example  
Frequency 3  
Recommendation is to group  
supplies by same frequency and  
share a ferrite bead among outputs  
of the same frequency.  
Figure 40. Example Application – Power System Schematic  
Figure 40 shows an example decoupling and bypassing scheme for the LMK0480x, which could apply to  
configurations shown in Figure 20 or Figure 39. Components drawn in dotted lines are optional (see Pin  
Connection Recommendations). Two power planes are used in these example designs, one for the clock outputs  
and one for PLL circuits. It is possible to reduce the number of decoupling components by tying together clock  
output Vcc pins for CLKouts that share the same frequency or otherwise can tolerate potential crosstalk between  
outputs with different frequencies. In the two examples, Vcc2 and Vcc3 can be tied together since CLKout2/3  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
123  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
System Examples (continued)  
and CLKout4/5 will operate at the same frequencies. Vcc10, Vcc11, and Vcc12 can be tied together since  
potential crosstalk between the FPGA/SerDes clocks and low-frequency synchronization clocks will not impact  
the performance of these digital interfaces, which typically have less stringent jitter requirements. PCB design will  
influence impedance to the supply. Vias and traces will increase the impedance to the power supply. Ensure  
good direct return current paths.  
9.4 Do's and Don'ts  
9.4.1 LVCMOS Complementary vs. Non-Complementary Operation  
It is recommended to use a complementary LVCMOS output format such as LVCMOS (Norm/Inv) to reduce  
switching noise and crosstalk when using LVCMOS.  
If only a single LVCMOS output is required, the complementary LVCMOS output format can still be used by  
leaving the unused LVCMOS output floating.  
A non-complimentary format such as LVCMOS (Norm/Norm) is not recommended as increased switching  
noise is present.  
9.4.2 LVPECL Outputs  
When using an LVPECL output it is not recommended to place a capacitor to ground on the output as might be  
done when using a capacitor input LC lowpass filter. The capacitor will appear as a short to the LVPECL output  
drivers which are able to supply large amounts of switching current. The effect of the LVPECL sourcing large  
switching currents can result in the following:  
1. Large switching currents through the Vcc pin of the LVPECL power supply resulting in more Vcc noise and  
possible Vcc spikes.  
2. Large switching currents injected into the ground plane through the capacitor which could couple onto other  
Vcc pins with bypass capacitors to ground resulting in more Vcc noise and possible Vcc spikes.  
124  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
10 Power Supply Recommendations  
10.1 Pin Connection Recommendations  
10.1.1 Vcc Pins and Decoupling  
All Vcc pins must always be connected.  
Integrated capacitance on the LMK0480x makes external high frequency decoupling capacitors (1 nF)  
unnecessary. The internal capacitance is more effective at filtering high frequency noise than off device bypass  
capacitance because there is no bond wire inductance between the LMK0480x circuit and the bypass capacitor.  
10.1.1.1 Vcc2, Vcc3, Vcc10, Vcc11, Vcc12, Vcc13 (CLKout Vccs)  
Each of these pins has an internal 200 pF of capacitance.  
Ferrite beads may be used to reduce crosstalk between different clock output frequencies on the same  
LMK0480x device. Ferrite beads placed between the power supply and a clock Vcc pin will reduce noise  
between the Vcc pin and the power supply. When several output clocks share the same frequency a single ferrite  
bead can be used between the power supply and each same frequency CLKout Vcc pin.  
When using ferrite beads on CLKout Vcc pins, consider the following guidelines to ensure the power supply will  
source the needed switching current:  
In most cases a ferrite bead may be placed and the internal capacitance is sufficient.  
If a ferrite bead is used with a low frequency output (typically 30 MHz) and a high current switching clock  
output format such as non-complementary LVCMOS or high swing LVPECL is used, then:  
The ferrite bead can be removed to the lower impedance to the main power supply and bypass capacitors,  
or  
Localized capacitance can be placed between the ferrite bead and Vcc pin to support the switching  
current.  
Note: the decoupling capacitors used between the ferrite bead and a CLKout Vcc pin can permit high  
frequency switching noise to couple through the capacitors into the ground plane and onto other  
CLKout Vcc pins with decoupling capacitors. This can degrade crosstalk performance.  
It is recommended to use a complementary LVCMOS output format such as LVCMOS (Norm/Inv) to  
reduce switching noise and crosstalk when using LVCMOS. If only a single LVCMOS output is required,  
the complementary LVCMOS output format can still be used by leaving the unused LVCMOS output  
floating.  
10.1.1.2 Vcc1 (VCO), Vcc4 (Digital), and Vcc9 (PLL2)  
Each of these pins has internal bypass capacitance.  
Ferrite beads should not be used between these pins and the power supply/large bypass capacitors because  
these Vcc pins don’t produce much noise and a ferrite bead can cause phase noise disturbances and  
resonances.  
The typical application diagram in Figure 40 shows all these Vccs connected to together to Vcc without a ferrite  
bead.  
10.1.1.3 Vcc6 (PLL1 Charge Pump) and Vcc8 (PLL2 Charge Pump)  
Each of these pins has an internal bypass capacitor.  
Use of a ferrite bead between the power supply/large bypass capacitors and PLL1 is optional. PLL1 charge  
pump can be connected directly to Vcc along with Vcc1, Vcc4, and Vcc9. Depending on the application, a 0.1 uF  
capacitor may be placed close to PLL1 charge pump Vcc pin.  
A ferrite bead should be placed between the power supply/large bypass capacitors and Vcc8. Most applications  
have high PLL2 phase detector frequencies and (> 50 MHz) such that the internal bypassing is sufficient and a  
ferrite bead can be used to isolate this switching noise from other circuits. For lower phase detector frequencies  
a ferrite bead is optional and depending on application a 0.1 uF capacitor may be added on Vcc8.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
125  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Pin Connection Recommendations (continued)  
10.1.1.4 Vcc5 (CLKin and OSCout1), Vcc7 (OSCin and OSCout0)  
Each of these pins has an internal 100 pF of capacitance. No ferrite bead should be placed between the power  
supply/large bypass capacitors and Vcc5 or Vcc7.  
These pins are unique since they supply an output clock and other circuitry.  
Vcc5 supplies CLKin and OSCout1.  
Vcc7 supplies OSCin, OSCout0, and PLL2 circuitry.  
Impacts of excessive noise on PLL2 circuitry may impact PLL2 DLD operation.  
It is recommended to use a complementary LVCMOS output format such as LVCMOS (Norm/Inv) to reduce  
switching noise and crosstalk when using LVCMOS. If only a single LVCMOS output is required, the  
complementary LVCMOS output format can still be used by leaving the unused LVCMOS output floating.  
10.1.2 LVPECL Outputs  
When using an LVPECL output it is not recommended to place a capacitor to ground on the output as might be  
done when using a capacitor input LC lowpass filter. The capacitor will appear as a short to the LVPECL output  
drivers which are able to supply large amounts of switching current. The effect of the LVPECL sourcing large  
switching currents can result in:  
1. Large switching currents through the Vcc pin of the LVPECL power supply resulting in more Vcc noise and  
possible Vcc spikes.  
2. Large switching currents injected into the ground plane through the capacitor which could couple onto other  
Vcc pins with bypass capacitors to ground resulting in more Vcc noise and possible Vcc spikes.  
10.1.3 Unused Clock Outputs  
Leave unused clock outputs floating and powered down.  
10.1.4 Unused Clock Inputs  
Unused clock inputs can be left floating.  
10.1.5 LDO Bypass  
The LDObyp1 and LDObyp2 pins should be connected to GND through external capacitors, as shown in  
Figure 40.  
10.2 Current Consumption and Power Dissipation Calculations  
From Table 127 the current consumption can be calculated for any configuration.  
For example, the current for the entire device with 1 LVDS (CLKout0) and 1 LVPECL 1.6 Vpp /w 240-Ω emitter  
resistors (CLKout1) output active with a clock output divide = 1, and no other features enabled can be calculated  
by adding up the following blocks: core current, clock buffer, one LVDS output buffer current, and one LVPECL  
output buffer current. There will also be one LVPECL output drawing emitter current, which means some of the  
power from the current draw of the device is dissipated in the external emitter resistors which doesn't add to the  
power dissipation budget for the device but is important for LDO ICC calculations.  
For total current consumption of the device, add up the significant functional blocks. In this example, 228.1 mA  
equals the sum of the following:  
140 mA (core current)  
17.3 mA (base clock distribution)  
25.5 mA (CLKout0 and 1 divider)  
14.3 mA (LVDS buffer)  
31 mA (LVPECL 1.6 Vpp buffer /w 240-Ω emitter resistors)  
126  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
Current Consumption and Power Dissipation Calculations (continued)  
Once total current consumption has been calculated, power dissipated by the device can be calculated. The  
power dissipation of the device is equation to the total current entering the device multiplied by the voltage at the  
device minus the power dissipated in any emitter resistors connected to any of the LVPECL outputs. If no emitter  
resistors are connected to the LVPECL outputs, this power will be 0 watts. Continuing the above example which  
has 228.1 mA total Icc and one output with 240-Ω emitter resistors. Total IC power = 717.7 mW = 3.3 V * 228.1  
mA - 35 mW.  
Table 127. Typical Current Consumption for Selected Functional Blocks  
(TA = 25 °C, VCC = 3.3 V)  
POWER  
POWER  
TYPICAL  
ICC  
DISSIPATED  
EXTERNALL  
Y(1)(2)(3)  
DISSIPATED  
in DEVICE  
(mW)  
BLOCK  
CONDITION  
(mA)  
(mW)  
CORE and FUNCTIONAL BLOCKS  
MODE = 0: Dual Loop, Internal  
VCO  
PLL1 and PLL2 locked  
140  
155  
127  
116  
103  
144  
462  
512  
419  
383  
340  
475  
-
-
-
-
-
MODE = 2: Dual Loop, Internal  
VCO, 0-Delay  
PLL1 and PLL2 locked; Includes  
EN_FEEDBACK_MUX = 1  
MODE = 3: Dual Loop, External  
VCO  
PLL1 and PLL2 locked  
PLL2 locked  
MODE = 6: Single Loop (PLL2),  
Internal VCO  
Core  
MODE = 11: Single Loop (PLL2),  
External VCO  
PLL2 locked  
MODE = 15: Dual PLL, 0-DELAY,  
External VCO  
PD_OSCin = 0  
PD_OSCin = 1  
42  
34.5  
2
139  
114  
6.6  
-
-
-
MODE = 16: Clock Distribution  
EN_TRACK  
Tracking is enabled (EN_TRACK = 1)  
At least 1 CLKoutX_Y_PD = 0  
Base Clock  
Distribution  
17.3  
2.8  
57.1  
9.2  
-
-
Each CLKout group (CLKout0/1 and 10/11, CLKout2/3 and 4/5, CLKout  
6/7 and 8/9)  
CLKout Group  
When a clock output is enabled, this contributes the divider/delay block  
Divider / digital delay in extended mode  
VCO Divider current  
25.5  
29.6  
7.7  
84.1  
97.7  
25.4  
7.2  
-
-
-
-
Clock Divider/  
Digital Delay  
VCO Divider  
HOLDOVER mode  
When in holdover mode  
2.2  
Feedback mux must be enabled for 0-delay modes and digital delay  
mode (SYNC_QUAL = 1)  
Feedback Mux  
SYNC Asserted  
EN_SYNC = 1  
SYNC_QUAL = 1  
4.9  
1.7  
6
16.1  
5.6  
-
-
-
While SYNC is asserted, this extra current is drawn  
Required for SYNC functionality. May be turned off once SYNC is  
complete to save power.  
19.8  
Delay enabled, delay > 7 (CLKout_MUX = 2, 3)  
XTAL_LVL = 0  
8.7  
1.8  
2.7  
3.6  
4.5  
2.8  
28.7  
5.9  
9
-
-
-
-
-
-
XTAL_LVL = 1  
Enabling the Crystal Oscillator  
XTAL_LVL = 2  
Crystal Mode  
12  
XTAL_LVL = 3  
15  
OSCin Doubler  
EN_PLL2_REF_2X = 1  
9.2  
(1) Power is dissipated externally in LVPECL emitter resistors. The externally dissipated power is calculated as twice the DC voltage level  
of one LVPECL clock output pin squared over the emitter resistance. That is to say power dissipated in emitter resistors = 2 * Vem2  
Rem.  
/
(2) Assuming R θJA = 15 °C/W, the total power dissipated on chip must be less than (125 °C – 85 °C) / 16 °C/W = 2.5 W to ensure a  
junction temperature is less than 125 °C.  
(3) Worst case power dissipation can be estimated by multiplying typical power dissipation with a factor of 1.15.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
127  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
Current Consumption and Power Dissipation Calculations (continued)  
Table 127. Typical Current Consumption for Selected Functional Blocks  
(TA = 25 °C, VCC = 3.3 V) (continued)  
POWER  
DISSIPATED  
EXTERNALL  
Y(1)(2)(3)  
POWER  
TYPICAL  
ICC  
(mA)  
DISSIPATED  
in DEVICE  
(mW)  
BLOCK  
CONDITION  
(mW)  
CLKoutX_Y_ANLG_DLY = 0 to 3  
3.4  
3.8  
4.2  
11.2  
12.5  
13.9  
-
-
-
CLKoutX_Y_ANLG_DLY = 4 to 7  
CLKoutX_Y_ANLG_DLY = 8 to 11  
Analog Delay Value  
CLKoutX_Y_ANLG_DLY = 12 to  
15  
4.7  
5.2  
15.5  
17.2  
-
-
Analog Delay  
CLKoutX_Y_ANLG_DLY = 16 to  
23  
Only Single Output Of Clock Pair Has Analog Delay Selected. Example:  
CLKout0_ADLY_SEL = 1 and CLKout1_ADLY_SEL = 0, or  
CLKout0_ADLY_SEL = 0 and CLKout1_ADLY_SEL = 1.  
2.8  
9.2  
-
CLOCK OUTPUT BUFFERS  
LVDS  
100-Ω differential termination  
14.3  
32  
47.2  
70.6  
67.3  
91.8  
59  
-
35  
35  
60  
40  
40  
-
LVPECL 2.0 Vpp, AC coupled using 240-Ω emitter resistors  
LVPECL 1.6 Vpp, AC coupled using 240-Ω emitter resistors  
LVPECL 1.6 Vpp, AC coupled using 120-Ω emitter resistors  
LVPECL 1.2 Vpp, AC coupled using 240-Ω emitter resistors  
LVPECL 0.7 Vpp, AC coupled using 240-Ω emitter resistors  
31  
LVPECL  
46  
30  
29  
55.7  
79.2  
87.5  
120.5  
49.5  
52.8  
71  
LVCMOS Pair (CLKoutX_TYPE  
= 6 to 9)  
CL = 5 pF  
3 MHz  
24  
30 MHz  
150 MHz  
26.5  
36.5  
15  
-
-
LVCMOS  
LVCMOS Single (CLKoutX_TYPE 3 MHz  
= 10 to 13)  
CL = 5 pF  
-
30 MHz  
16  
-
150 MHz  
21.5  
-
128  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
11 Layout  
11.1 Layout Guidelines  
Power consumption of the LMK0480x family of devices can be high enough to require attention to thermal  
management. For reliability and performance reasons the die temperature should be limited to a maximum of  
125 °C. That is, as an estimate, TA (ambient temperature) plus device power consumption times RθJA should not  
exceed 125 °C.  
The package of the device has an exposed pad that provides the primary heat removal path as well as excellent  
electrical grounding to a printed circuit board. To maximize the removal of heat from the package a thermal land  
pattern including multiple vias to a ground plane must be incorporated on the PCB within the footprint of the  
package. The exposed pad must be soldered down to ensure adequate heat conduction out of the package.  
A recommended land and via pattern is shown in Figure 41. More information on soldering WQFN packages can  
be obtained from www.ti.com/packaging/. See also the packaging information in Mechanical, Packaging, and  
Orderable Information.  
To minimize junction temperature, it is recommended that a simple heat sink be built into the PCB (if the ground  
plane layer is not exposed). This is done by including a copper area on the opposite side of the PCB from the  
device. This copper area may be plated or solder coated to prevent corrosion, but should not have conformal  
coating (if possible), which could provide thermal insulation. The vias shown in Figure 41 should connect these  
top and bottom copper layers and to the ground layer. These vias act as “heat pipes” to carry the thermal energy  
away from the device side of the board to where it can be more effectively dissipated. Avoid routing traces close  
to exposed ground pad to ensure proper thermal flow on the PCB.  
7.2 mm  
0.2 mm  
1.46 mm  
1.15 mm  
Figure 41. Recommended Land and Via Pattern  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
129  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
 
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
www.ti.com  
11.2 Layout Example  
CLKin and OSCin path ± if differential input (preferred) route trace  
tightly coupled like clock outputs. If single ended, have at least 3 trace  
width (of CLKin/OSCin trace) separation from other RF traces.  
Example shown is hybrid for both differential and single ended ± not  
tightly couple to compromise for both configurations. RF Terminations  
should be placed as close to IC as possible. When using CLKin1 for  
high frequency input for external VCO or distribution, a 3 dB pi pad is  
suggested for termination.  
Charge pump output ± shorter traces are better.  
Place all resistors and caps closer to IC except for  
a single capacitor next to VCXO. In a 2nd order  
filter place C1 close to VCXO Vtune pin. In a 3rd  
and 4th order filter place C3 or C4 respectively  
close to VCXO.  
Clock outputs ± differential signals, should be  
routed tightly coupled to minimize PCB crosstalk.  
Trace impedance and terminations should be  
designed according to output type being used (i.e.  
LVDS, LVPECL...)  
)RUꢀ&/.RXWꢀ9FF¶VꢀSODFHꢀIHUULWHꢀEHDGVꢀRQꢀWRSꢀOD\HUꢀFORVHꢀWRꢀSLQVꢀWRꢀFKRNHꢀ  
high frequency noise from via.  
Figure 42. LMK0480x Layout Example  
130  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
LMK04803, LMK04805, LMK04806, LMK04808  
www.ti.com  
SNAS489K MARCH 2011REVISED DECEMBER 2014  
12 Device and Documentation Support  
12.1 Device Support  
12.1.1 Development Support  
For additional support, see the following:  
Clock Design Tool: http://www.ti.com/tool/clockdesigntool  
Clock Architect: http://www.ti.com/lsds/ti/analog/webench/clock-architect.page  
12.2 Documentation Support  
12.2.1 Related Documentation  
For additional information, see the following:  
Common Data Transmission Parameters and their Definitions, Application Note AN-912 (SNLA036)  
Crystal Based Oscillator Design with the LMK04000 Family, Application Note AN-1939 (SNAA065)  
Frequency Synthesis and Planning for PLL Architectures, Application Note AN-1865 (SNAA061)  
12.3 Related Links  
The table below lists quick access links. Categories include technical documents, support and community  
resources, tools and software, and quick access to sample or buy.  
Table 128. Related Links  
TECHNICAL  
DOCUMENTS  
TOOLS &  
SOFTWARE  
SUPPORT &  
COMMUNITY  
PARTS  
PRODUCT FOLDER  
SAMPLE & BUY  
LMK04803  
LMK04805  
LMK04806  
LMK04808  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
Click here  
12.4 Trademarks  
PLLatinum is a trademark of Texas Instruments.  
All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.  
12.5 Electrostatic Discharge Caution  
These devices have limited built-in ESD protection. The leads should be shorted together or the device placed in conductive foam  
during storage or handling to prevent electrostatic damage to the MOS gates.  
12.6 Glossary  
SLYZ022 TI Glossary.  
This glossary lists and explains terms, acronyms, and definitions.  
13 Mechanical, Packaging, and Orderable Information  
The following pages include mechanical, packaging, and orderable information. This information is the most  
current data available for the designated devices. This data is subject to change without notice and revision of  
this document. For browser-based versions of this data sheet, refer to the left-hand navigation.  
Copyright © 2011–2014, Texas Instruments Incorporated  
Submit Documentation Feedback  
131  
Product Folder Links: LMK04803 LMK04805 LMK04806 LMK04808  
PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM  
www.ti.com  
10-Dec-2020  
PACKAGING INFORMATION  
Orderable Device  
Status Package Type Package Pins Package  
Eco Plan  
Lead finish/  
Ball material  
MSL Peak Temp  
Op Temp (°C)  
Device Marking  
Samples  
Drawing  
Qty  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(4/5)  
(6)  
LMK04803BISQ/NOPB  
LMK04803BISQE/NOPB  
LMK04803BISQX/NOPB  
LMK04805BISQ/NOPB  
LMK04805BISQE/NOPB  
LMK04805BISQX/NOPB  
LMK04806BISQ/NOPB  
LMK04806BISQE/NOPB  
LMK04806BISQX/NOPB  
LMK04808BISQ/NOPB  
LMK04808BISQE/NOPB  
LMK04808BISQX/NOPB  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
ACTIVE  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
1000 RoHS & Green  
250 RoHS & Green  
SN  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
Level-3-260C-168 HR  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
-40 to 85  
K04803BISQ  
SN  
SN  
SN  
SN  
SN  
SN  
SN  
SN  
SN  
SN  
SN  
K04803BISQ  
K04803BISQ  
K04805BISQ  
K04805BISQ  
K04805BISQ  
K04806BISQ  
K04806BISQ  
K04806BISQ  
K04808BISQ  
K04808BISQ  
K04808BISQ  
2000 RoHS & Green  
1000 RoHS & Green  
250  
RoHS & Green  
2000 RoHS & Green  
1000 RoHS & Green  
250  
RoHS & Green  
2000 RoHS & Green  
1000 RoHS & Green  
250  
RoHS & Green  
2000 RoHS & Green  
(1) The marketing status values are defined as follows:  
ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs.  
LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect.  
NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design.  
PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available.  
OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device.  
(2) RoHS: TI defines "RoHS" to mean semiconductor products that are compliant with the current EU RoHS requirements for all 10 RoHS substances, including the requirement that RoHS substance  
do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, "RoHS" products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. TI may  
reference these types of products as "Pb-Free".  
RoHS Exempt: TI defines "RoHS Exempt" to mean products that contain lead but are compliant with EU RoHS pursuant to a specific EU RoHS exemption.  
Green: TI defines "Green" to mean the content of Chlorine (Cl) and Bromine (Br) based flame retardants meet JS709B low halogen requirements of <=1000ppm threshold. Antimony trioxide based  
flame retardants must also meet the <=1000ppm threshold requirement.  
Addendum-Page 1  
PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM  
www.ti.com  
10-Dec-2020  
(3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature.  
(4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device.  
(5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation  
of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device.  
(6)  
Lead finish/Ball material - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead finish/Ball material values may wrap to two  
lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width.  
Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information  
provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and  
continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals.  
TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release.  
In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis.  
Addendum-Page 2  
PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION  
www.ti.com  
9-Aug-2022  
TAPE AND REEL INFORMATION  
REEL DIMENSIONS  
TAPE DIMENSIONS  
K0  
P1  
W
B0  
Reel  
Diameter  
Cavity  
A0  
A0 Dimension designed to accommodate the component width  
B0 Dimension designed to accommodate the component length  
K0 Dimension designed to accommodate the component thickness  
Overall width of the carrier tape  
W
P1 Pitch between successive cavity centers  
Reel Width (W1)  
QUADRANT ASSIGNMENTS FOR PIN 1 ORIENTATION IN TAPE  
Sprocket Holes  
Q1 Q2  
Q3 Q4  
Q1 Q2  
Q3 Q4  
User Direction of Feed  
Pocket Quadrants  
*All dimensions are nominal  
Device  
Package Package Pins  
Type Drawing  
SPQ  
Reel  
Reel  
A0  
B0  
K0  
P1  
W
Pin1  
Diameter Width (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) Quadrant  
(mm) W1 (mm)  
LMK04803BISQ/NOPB  
WQFN  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
1000  
250  
330.0  
178.0  
330.0  
330.0  
178.0  
330.0  
330.0  
178.0  
330.0  
330.0  
178.0  
330.0  
16.4  
16.4  
16.4  
16.4  
16.4  
16.4  
16.4  
16.4  
16.4  
16.4  
16.4  
16.4  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
9.3  
1.3  
1.3  
1.3  
1.3  
1.3  
1.3  
1.3  
1.3  
1.3  
1.3  
1.3  
1.3  
12.0  
12.0  
12.0  
12.0  
12.0  
12.0  
12.0  
12.0  
12.0  
12.0  
12.0  
12.0  
16.0  
16.0  
16.0  
16.0  
16.0  
16.0  
16.0  
16.0  
16.0  
16.0  
16.0  
16.0  
Q1  
Q1  
Q1  
Q1  
Q1  
Q1  
Q1  
Q1  
Q1  
Q1  
Q1  
Q1  
LMK04803BISQE/NOPB WQFN  
LMK04803BISQX/NOPB WQFN  
2000  
1000  
250  
LMK04805BISQ/NOPB  
WQFN  
LMK04805BISQE/NOPB WQFN  
LMK04805BISQX/NOPB WQFN  
2000  
1000  
250  
LMK04806BISQ/NOPB  
WQFN  
LMK04806BISQE/NOPB WQFN  
LMK04806BISQX/NOPB WQFN  
2000  
1000  
250  
LMK04808BISQ/NOPB  
WQFN  
LMK04808BISQE/NOPB WQFN  
LMK04808BISQX/NOPB WQFN  
2000  
Pack Materials-Page 1  
PACKAGE MATERIALS INFORMATION  
www.ti.com  
9-Aug-2022  
TAPE AND REEL BOX DIMENSIONS  
Width (mm)  
H
W
L
*All dimensions are nominal  
Device  
Package Type Package Drawing Pins  
SPQ  
Length (mm) Width (mm) Height (mm)  
LMK04803BISQ/NOPB  
LMK04803BISQE/NOPB  
LMK04803BISQX/NOPB  
LMK04805BISQ/NOPB  
LMK04805BISQE/NOPB  
LMK04805BISQX/NOPB  
LMK04806BISQ/NOPB  
LMK04806BISQE/NOPB  
LMK04806BISQX/NOPB  
LMK04808BISQ/NOPB  
LMK04808BISQE/NOPB  
LMK04808BISQX/NOPB  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
WQFN  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
NKD  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
64  
1000  
250  
356.0  
208.0  
356.0  
356.0  
208.0  
356.0  
356.0  
208.0  
356.0  
356.0  
208.0  
356.0  
356.0  
191.0  
356.0  
356.0  
191.0  
356.0  
356.0  
191.0  
356.0  
356.0  
191.0  
356.0  
35.0  
35.0  
35.0  
35.0  
35.0  
35.0  
35.0  
35.0  
35.0  
35.0  
35.0  
35.0  
2000  
1000  
250  
2000  
1000  
250  
2000  
1000  
250  
2000  
Pack Materials-Page 2  
GENERIC PACKAGE VIEW  
NKD 64  
9 x 9, 0.5 mm pitch  
WQFN - 0.8 mm max height  
PLASTIC QUAD FLATPACK - NO LEAD  
This image is a representation of the package family, actual package may vary.  
Refer to the product data sheet for package details.  
4229637/A  
www.ti.com  
PACKAGE OUTLINE  
NKD0064A  
WQFN - 0.8 mm max height  
S
C
A
L
E
1
.
6
0
0
WQFN  
9.1  
8.9  
A
B
PIN 1 INDEX AREA  
0.5  
0.3  
9.1  
8.9  
0.3  
0.2  
DETAIL  
OPTIONAL TERMINAL  
TYPICAL  
0.8 MAX  
C
SEATING PLANE  
(0.1)  
TYP  
7.2 0.1  
SEE TERMINAL  
DETAIL  
17  
32  
60X 0.5  
33  
16  
4X  
7.5  
1
48  
0.3  
64X  
PIN 1 ID  
64  
49  
0.2  
(OPTIONAL)  
0.1  
C A  
C
B
0.5  
0.3  
64X  
0.05  
4214996/A 08/2013  
NOTES:  
1. All linear dimensions are in millimeters. Dimensions in parenthesis are for reference only. Dimensioning and tolerancing  
per ASME Y14.5M.  
2. This drawing is subject to change without notice.  
3. The package thermal pad must be soldered to the printed circuit board for thermal and mechanical performance.  
www.ti.com  
EXAMPLE BOARD LAYOUT  
NKD0064A  
WQFN - 0.8 mm max height  
WQFN  
(
7.2)  
SYMM  
64X (0.6)  
64X (0.25)  
SEE DETAILS  
49  
64  
1
48  
60X (0.5)  
SYMM  
(8.8)  
(1.36)  
TYP  
8X (1.31)  
33  
(
0.2) VIA  
TYP  
16  
17  
32  
(1.36) TYP  
8X (1.31)  
(8.8)  
LAND PATTERN EXAMPLE  
SCALE:8X  
0.07 MAX  
ALL AROUND  
0.07 MIN  
ALL AROUND  
METAL  
SOLDER MASK  
OPENING  
SOLDER MASK  
OPENING  
METAL  
NON SOLDER MASK  
DEFINED  
SOLDER MASK  
DEFINED  
(PREFERRED)  
SOLDER MASK DETAILS  
4214996/A 08/2013  
NOTES: (continued)  
4. This package is designed to be soldered to a thermal pad on the board. For more information, refer to QFN/SON PCB application note  
in literature No. SLUA271 (www.ti.com/lit/slua271).  
www.ti.com  
EXAMPLE STENCIL DESIGN  
NKD0064A  
WQFN - 0.8 mm max height  
WQFN  
SYMM  
(1.36) TYP  
49  
64X (0.6)  
64X (0.25)  
64  
1
48  
(1.36)  
TYP  
60X (0.5)  
SYMM  
(8.8)  
METAL  
TYP  
16  
33  
17  
32  
25X (1.16)  
(8.8)  
SOLDERPASTE EXAMPLE  
BASED ON 0.125mm THICK STENCIL  
EXPOSED PAD  
65% PRINTED SOLDER COVERAGE BY AREA  
SCALE:10X  
4214996/A 08/2013  
NOTES: (continued)  
5. Laser cutting apertures with trapezoidal walls and rounded corners may offer better paste release. IPC-7525 may have alternate  
design recommendations.  
www.ti.com  
IMPORTANT NOTICE AND DISCLAIMER  
TI PROVIDES TECHNICAL AND RELIABILITY DATA (INCLUDING DATA SHEETS), DESIGN RESOURCES (INCLUDING REFERENCE  
DESIGNS), APPLICATION OR OTHER DESIGN ADVICE, WEB TOOLS, SAFETY INFORMATION, AND OTHER RESOURCES “AS IS”  
AND WITH ALL FAULTS, AND DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESS AND IMPLIED, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION ANY  
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR NON-INFRINGEMENT OF THIRD  
PARTY INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS.  
These resources are intended for skilled developers designing with TI products. You are solely responsible for (1) selecting the appropriate  
TI products for your application, (2) designing, validating and testing your application, and (3) ensuring your application meets applicable  
standards, and any other safety, security, regulatory or other requirements.  
These resources are subject to change without notice. TI grants you permission to use these resources only for development of an  
application that uses the TI products described in the resource. Other reproduction and display of these resources is prohibited. No license  
is granted to any other TI intellectual property right or to any third party intellectual property right. TI disclaims responsibility for, and you  
will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against, any claims, damages, costs, losses, and liabilities arising out of your use of these  
resources.  
TI’s products are provided subject to TI’s Terms of Sale or other applicable terms available either on ti.com or provided in conjunction with  
such TI products. TI’s provision of these resources does not expand or otherwise alter TI’s applicable warranties or warranty disclaimers for  
TI products.  
TI objects to and rejects any additional or different terms you may have proposed. IMPORTANT NOTICE  
Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265  
Copyright © 2023, Texas Instruments Incorporated  

相关型号:

LMK04806BISQX/NOPB

具有双级联 PLL 和集成式 2.5GHz VCO 的低噪声时钟抖动消除器 | NKD | 64 | -40 to 85
TI

LMK04808

具有双环路 PLL 和集成式 2.9GHz VCO 的低噪声时钟抖动消除器
TI

LMK04808B

Low-Noise Clock Jitter Cleaner with Dual Loop PLLs
TI

LMK04808BISQ

Low-Noise Clock Jitter Cleaner with Dual Loop PLLs
TI

LMK04808BISQ/NOPB

具有双环路 PLL 和集成式 2.9GHz VCO 的低噪声时钟抖动消除器 | NKD | 64 | -40 to 85
TI

LMK04808BISQE/NOPB

Low-Noise Clock Jitter Cleaner with Dual Loop PLLs and Integrated 2.9 GHz VCO 64-WQFN -40 to 85
TI

LMK04808BISQX/NOPB

具有双环路 PLL 和集成式 2.9GHz VCO 的低噪声时钟抖动消除器 | NKD | 64 | -40 to 85
TI

LMK04816

LMK04816 Three Input Low-Noise Clock Jitter Cleaner with Dual Loop PLLs
TI

LMK04816BISQ

LMK04816 Three Input Low-Noise Clock Jitter Cleaner with Dual Loop PLLs
TI

LMK04816BISQ/NOPB

具有双环 PLL 的三输入低噪声时钟抖动消除器 | NKD | 64 | -40 to 85
TI

LMK04816BISQE

LMK04816 Three Input Low-Noise Clock Jitter Cleaner with Dual Loop PLLs
TI

LMK04816BISQE/NOPB

具有双环 PLL 的三输入低噪声时钟抖动消除器 | NKD | 64
TI